blob: 6bb5ffdc6e2b4b8b35b5b50b6ac3ef3db850b62c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02007 2014/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
498 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100499 - tune.zlib.memlevel
500 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502 * Debugging
503 - debug
504 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505
506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508------------------------------------
509
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200510ca-base <dir>
511 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200512 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
513 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515chroot <jail dir>
516 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
517 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
518 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
519 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
520 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
521 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100522
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100523cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
524 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
525 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
526 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
527 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
528 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
529 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
530 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
531 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
532 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
533 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
534 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
535 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
536 they overlap.
537
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200538crt-base <dir>
539 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
540 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
541 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543daemon
544 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
545 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
546 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
547
548gid <number>
549 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
550 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
551 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100552 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
553 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556group <group name>
557 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
558 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100559
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200560log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
562 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100563 configured with "log global".
564
565 <address> can be one of:
566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100567 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100568 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
569 port).
570
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100571 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
572 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
573 port).
574
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100575 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
576 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
577 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
578 writeable).
579
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100580 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
581 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
582 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
583 in Bourne shell.
584
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100585 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586
587 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
588 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
589 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
590
591 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200592 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
593 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
594 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
595 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
596 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
597 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200599 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601log-send-hostname [<string>]
602 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
603 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
604 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
605 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
606 the logs.
607
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000608log-tag <string>
609 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
610 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
611 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
612 running on the same host.
613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614nbproc <number>
615 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
616 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
617 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
618 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
619 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
620
621pidfile <pidfile>
622 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
623 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
624 starting the process. See also "daemon".
625
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100626stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200627 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
628 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
629 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
630 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
631 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
632 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
633 the number of processes used.
634
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100635ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
637 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100639 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
640 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
641 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
642 "bind" keyword for more information.
643
644ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
646 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300647 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100648 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
649 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
650 information.
651
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100652ssl-server-verify [none|required]
653 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
654 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
655 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
656
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200657stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
658 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
659 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
660 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
661 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200662
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200663 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
664 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
665 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200666
667stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
668 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
669 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100670 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200671
672stats maxconn <connections>
673 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
674 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676uid <number>
677 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
678 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
679 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
680 one. See also "gid" and "user".
681
682ulimit-n <number>
683 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
684 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
685 option.
686
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100687unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
688 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
689
690 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
691 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
692 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
693 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
694 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
695 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
696 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
697 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
698 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
699 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701user <user name>
702 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
703 See also "uid" and "group".
704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200705node <name>
706 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
707
708 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
709 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
710 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
711 traffic.
712
713description <text>
714 Add a text that describes the instance.
715
716 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
717 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
718 "<" and ">" characters.
719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722-----------------------
723
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200724max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
725 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
726 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
727 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
728 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
729 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
730 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
731 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
732 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734maxconn <number>
735 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
736 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
737 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
738 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
739
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200740maxconnrate <number>
741 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
742 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
743 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
744 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
745 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
746 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
747 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
748 fairness.
749
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100750maxcomprate <number>
751 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300752 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
754 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
755 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
756 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
757 default value.
758
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100759maxcompcpuusage <number>
760 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
761 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
762 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
763 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
764 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
765 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
766 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
767 process down and from introducing high latencies.
768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769maxpipes <number>
770 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
771 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
772 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
773 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
774 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
775 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
776
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200777maxsessrate <number>
778 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
779 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
780 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
781 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
782 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
783 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
784 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
785 fairness.
786
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200787maxsslconn <number>
788 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
789 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
790 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
791 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
792 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
793 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
794 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
795
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200796maxsslrate <number>
797 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
798 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
799 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
800 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
801 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
802 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
803 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
804 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
805 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
806 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
807
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100808maxzlibmem <number>
809 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
810 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
811 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100812 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
813 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
814 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816noepoll
817 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
818 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100819 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
821nokqueue
822 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
823 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
824 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
825
826nopoll
827 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
828 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100830 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100832nosplice
833 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
834 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
835 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100836 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100837 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
838 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
839 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
840 "option splice-response".
841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842nogetaddrinfo
843 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
844 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
845
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200846spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900847 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
848 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
849 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
850 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
851 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
852 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200853
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200854tune.bufsize <number>
855 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
856 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
857 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
858 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
859 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
860 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
861 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
862 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400863 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
864 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
865 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200866
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200867tune.chksize <number>
868 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
869 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
870 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
871 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
872 checks whenever possible.
873
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100874tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
875 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
876 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
877 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
878 this value. The default value is 1.
879
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100880tune.http.cookielen <number>
881 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
882 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
883 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
884 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
885 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
886 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
887 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
888 to change this value.
889
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200890tune.http.maxhdr <number>
891 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
892 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
893 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
894 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
895 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
896 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
897 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
898 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
899 limit too high.
900
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100901tune.idletimer <timeout>
902 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
903 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
904 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
905 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
906 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
907 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
908 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
909 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
910 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
911
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100912tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100913 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
914 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
915 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
916 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
917 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
918 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
919 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
920 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
921 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
922 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100923
924tune.maxpollevents <number>
925 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
926 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
927 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
928 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
929 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
930
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200931tune.maxrewrite <number>
932 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
933 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
934 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
935 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
936 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
937 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
938 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
939 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
940 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
941 bufsize.
942
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200943tune.pipesize <number>
944 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
945 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
946 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
947 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
948 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
949 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
950
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100951tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
952tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
953 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
954 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
955 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
956 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
957 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
958 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
959 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
960
961tune.sndbuf.client <number>
962tune.sndbuf.server <number>
963 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
964 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
965 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
966 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
967 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
968 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
969 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
970 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
971 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
972 notifying haproxy again.
973
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100974tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100975 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
976 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
977 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300978 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100979 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
980 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
981 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
982 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
983 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100984 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
985 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100986
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100987tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
988 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300989 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100990 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
991 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
992 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
993 being used for too long.
994
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100995tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
996 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
997 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
998 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
999 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1000 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1001 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1002 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1003 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1004 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1005 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001006 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1007 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001008
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001009tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1010 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001011 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001012 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1013 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1014 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1015
1016tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1017 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1018 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1019 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1020 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010223.3. Debugging
1023--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024
1025debug
1026 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1027 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1028 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1029 system startup.
1030
1031quiet
1032 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1033 line argument "-q".
1034
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010363.4. Userlists
1037--------------
1038It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1039http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1040it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1041
1042userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001043 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001044 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1045
1046group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001047 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001048 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1049 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1050
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001051user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1052 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001053 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1054 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001055 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1056 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001057 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001058 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059
1060
1061 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062 userlist L1
1063 group G1 users tiger,scott
1064 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1067 user scott insecure-password elgato
1068 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001069
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001070 userlist L2
1071 group G1
1072 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001073
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001074 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1075 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1076 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001077
1078 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001080
10813.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001082----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001083It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1084haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1085pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1086identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1087or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1088Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1089known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1090the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1091process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1092during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1093tables.
1094
1095peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001096 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001097 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1098
1099peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1100 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1101 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1102 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1103 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1104 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1105 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1106
1107 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1108 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1109
1110 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1111 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1112 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1113 across all peers.
1114
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001115 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1116 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1117 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1118
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001119 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001120 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001121 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1122 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1123 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
1125 backend mybackend
1126 mode tcp
1127 balance roundrobin
1128 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1129 stick on src
1130
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001131 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1132 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001133
1134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1139 - defaults <name>
1140 - frontend <name>
1141 - backend <name>
1142 - listen <name>
1143
1144A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1145its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1146section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148
1149A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1150connections.
1151
1152A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1153to forward incoming connections.
1154
1155A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1156parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1159'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1160case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1161
1162Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1163logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1164proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1165However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1166name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1167
1168Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1169and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001170bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001171protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1172modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1173arbitrary criteria.
1174
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001175In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1176a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1177the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1178
1179 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1180 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1181 between responses and new requests.
1182
1183 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1184 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1185 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1186 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1187
1188 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1189 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1190 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1191
1192 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1193 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1194 client-facing connection remains open.
1195
1196 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1197 after the end of the response.
1198
1199The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1200frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1201following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1202weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1203
1204 Backend mode
1205
1206 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1207 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1208 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1209 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1210 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1211 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1212 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1213 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1214 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1215 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1216 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1221--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001223The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1224limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1225they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1226limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001227marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001228option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001229and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1230with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1231specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1235------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1236acl - X X X
1237appsession - - X X
1238backlog X X X -
1239balance X - X X
1240bind - X X -
1241bind-process X X X X
1242block - X X X
1243capture cookie - X X -
1244capture request header - X X -
1245capture response header - X X -
1246clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001247compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001248contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1249cookie X - X X
1250default-server X - X X
1251default_backend X X X -
1252description - X X X
1253disabled X X X X
1254dispatch - - X X
1255enabled X X X X
1256errorfile X X X X
1257errorloc X X X X
1258errorloc302 X X X X
1259-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1260errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001261force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001262fullconn X - X X
1263grace X X X X
1264hash-type X - X X
1265http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001266http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001267http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001269http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001270http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001273log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001274max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001275maxconn X X X -
1276mode X X X X
1277monitor fail - X X -
1278monitor-net X X X -
1279monitor-uri X X X -
1280option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1281option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1282option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1283option allbackups (*) X - X X
1284option checkcache (*) X - X X
1285option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1286option contstats (*) X X X -
1287option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1288option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1289option forceclose (*) X X X X
1290-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1291option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001292option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001293option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001294option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001295option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001296option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001297option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1298option httpchk X - X X
1299option httpclose (*) X X X X
1300option httplog X X X X
1301option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001302option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001303option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001304option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1305option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1306option logasap (*) X X X -
1307option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001308option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309option nolinger (*) X X X X
1310option originalto X X X X
1311option persist (*) X - X X
1312option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001313option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314option smtpchk X - X X
1315option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1316option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1317option splice-request (*) X X X X
1318option splice-response (*) X X X X
1319option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1320option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1321-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001322option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1324option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1325option tcpka X X X X
1326option tcplog X X X X
1327option transparent (*) X - X X
1328persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1329rate-limit sessions X X X -
1330redirect - X X X
1331redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1332redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1333reqadd - X X X
1334reqallow - X X X
1335reqdel - X X X
1336reqdeny - X X X
1337reqiallow - X X X
1338reqidel - X X X
1339reqideny - X X X
1340reqipass - X X X
1341reqirep - X X X
1342reqisetbe - X X X
1343reqitarpit - X X X
1344reqpass - X X X
1345reqrep - X X X
1346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1347reqsetbe - X X X
1348reqtarpit - X X X
1349retries X - X X
1350rspadd - X X X
1351rspdel - X X X
1352rspdeny - X X X
1353rspidel - X X X
1354rspideny - X X X
1355rspirep - X X X
1356rsprep - X X X
1357server - - X X
1358source X - X X
1359srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001360stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361stats auth X - X X
1362stats enable X - X X
1363stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001364stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001365stats realm X - X X
1366stats refresh X - X X
1367stats scope X - X X
1368stats show-desc X - X X
1369stats show-legends X - X X
1370stats show-node X - X X
1371stats uri X - X X
1372-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1373stick match - - X X
1374stick on - - X X
1375stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001376stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001377stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001378tcp-check connect - - X X
1379tcp-check expect - - X X
1380tcp-check send - - X X
1381tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001382tcp-request connection - X X -
1383tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001384tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001385tcp-response content - - X X
1386tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387timeout check X - X X
1388timeout client X X X -
1389timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1390timeout connect X - X X
1391timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1392timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1393timeout http-request X X X X
1394timeout queue X - X X
1395timeout server X - X X
1396timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1397timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001398timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001400unique-id-format X X X -
1401unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001402use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001403use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001404------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1405 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1409---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410
1411This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1412
1413
1414acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1415 Declare or complete an access list.
1416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1417 no | yes | yes | yes
1418 Example:
1419 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1420 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1421 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001423 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
1425
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001426appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1427 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001428 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | no | yes | yes
1431 Arguments :
1432 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1433 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1434
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001435 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436 checked in each cookie value.
1437
1438 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1439 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1440 milliseconds.
1441
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001442 request-learn
1443 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1444 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1445 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1446 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1447 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1448 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1449
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001450 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1451 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1452 data following this prefix.
1453
1454 Example :
1455 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1456
1457 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1458 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1459
1460 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1461 2 modes are currently supported :
1462 - path-parameters :
1463 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1464 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1465 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1466 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1467 - query-string :
1468 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1469 query string.
1470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1472 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1473 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1474 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1476 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1477 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1479 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1480
1481 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1482
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001483 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1484 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1485 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487 Example :
1488 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001490 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1491 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492
1493
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001494backlog <conns>
1495 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1497 yes | yes | yes | no
1498 Arguments :
1499 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1500 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001501 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001502
1503 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1504 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1505 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1506 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1507 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1508 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1509 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1510 backlog parameter.
1511
1512 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1513 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1514 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1515
1516 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1517
1518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001520balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1523 yes | no | yes | yes
1524 Arguments :
1525 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1526 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1527 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1528 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1529
1530 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1531 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1532 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1533 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001534 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001535 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001536 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1537 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1538 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1539 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1540 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1541 it, so that you don't worry.
1542
1543 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1545 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1546 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1547 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1548 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1549 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1550 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001552 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1553 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1554 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1555 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1556 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1557 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1558 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1559 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1560
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001561 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001562 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001563 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1564 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001565 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001566 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1567 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1568 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1569 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1570 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001571 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1572 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1573 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1574 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1575 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1576 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1579 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1580 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1581 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1582 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1583 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1584 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1585 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001586 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001587 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001588 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1589 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1590 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001592 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1593 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1594 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1595 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1596 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1597 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1598 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1599 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1600 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1603 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001606 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1607 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1608 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1609 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1610 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1611 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1612 URIs start with a leading "/".
1613
1614 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1615 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1616 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1617 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001619 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001620 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1621
1622 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1624 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001625 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1626 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1627 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1628 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001629 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001630 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1631 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001632
1633 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1634 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1635 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1636 server will receive the request.
1637
1638 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1639 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1640 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1641 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1642 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1644 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1645 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001647 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1648 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1649 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1650 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1651 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001653 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001654 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1655 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1656 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1657
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001658 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1659 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1660 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1661
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001662 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001663 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001664 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1665 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1666 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1667 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1668 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1669 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001670 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001671 used instead.
1672
1673 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1674 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1675 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1676 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1677
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001678 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1679 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1680 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1681
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001682 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001685 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1686 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001688 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1689 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1690 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
1692 Examples :
1693 balance roundrobin
1694 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001696 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1697 balance hdr(host)
1698 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001699
1700 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1701 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001703 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001704 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1705 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1706 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1707 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1708
1709 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1710 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1711 defaults to 16 kB.
1712
1713 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1714 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1715
1716 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1717 Round Robin.
1718
1719 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1720 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1721 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1722 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1723
1724 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1725
1726 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001728 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1729 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1730 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001732 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1733 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734
1735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001736bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1737bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1740 no | yes | yes | no
1741 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001742 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1743 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1744 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1745 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001746 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001747 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1748 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1749 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1750 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1751 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1752 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1753 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001754 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1755 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1756 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001757 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1758 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1759 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1760 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001761
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001762 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1763 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001764 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1765 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1766 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001767 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1768 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1769 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1770 the range.
1771
1772 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1773 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1774 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1775 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1776 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1777 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1778 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001780 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001782 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1783 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1784 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1785 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1786 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1787 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1788 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1789 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1792 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1793 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1794 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1797 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1798 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1799 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1800 in a frontend.
1801
1802 Example :
1803 listen http_proxy
1804 bind :80,:443
1805 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001806 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001808 listen http_https_proxy
1809 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001810 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001811
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001812 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1813 bind ipv6@:80
1814 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1815 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1816
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001817 listen external_bind_app1
1818 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001821 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822
1823
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001824bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001825 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1827 yes | yes | yes | yes
1828 Arguments :
1829 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1830 may be used to override a default value.
1831
1832 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1833 option may be combined with other numbers.
1834
1835 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1836 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1837 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1838 missing from all processes.
1839
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001840 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1841 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1842 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1843 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1844 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001845
1846 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1847 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1848 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1849 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1850 and 'even' instances.
1851
1852 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1853 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1854 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1855 32.
1856
1857 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1858 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1859
1860 Example :
1861 listen app_ip1
1862 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001863 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001864
1865 listen app_ip2
1866 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001867 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001868
1869 listen management
1870 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001871 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001873 listen management
1874 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1875 bind-process 1-4
1876
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001877 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1878
1879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880block { if | unless } <condition>
1881 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 no | yes | yes | yes
1884
1885 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1886 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001887 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001888 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1890 "block" statements per instance.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1894 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1895 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1896 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001898 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900
1901capture cookie <name> len <length>
1902 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 no | yes | yes | no
1905 Arguments :
1906 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1907 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1908 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1909 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1910 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1911
1912 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1913 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1914 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1915 right if it exceeds <length>.
1916
1917 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1918 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1919 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1920 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1921
1922 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1923 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1924 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1925
1926 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1927 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1928 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001929 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1930 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1931 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933 Example:
1934 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1935
1936 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001937 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
1939
1940capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001941 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 no | yes | yes | no
1944 Arguments :
1945 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001946 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1948 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1949 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1950
1951 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1952 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1953 it exceeds <length>.
1954
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001955 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1957 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001958 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1959 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1960 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1961 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001962 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001963 environments to find where the request came from.
1964
1965 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1966 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1967 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1968 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001970 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1971 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1972 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1973 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1974 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975
1976 Example:
1977 capture request header Host len 15
1978 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1979 capture request header Referrer len 15
1980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001981 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982 about logging.
1983
1984
1985capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001986 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1988 no | yes | yes | no
1989 Arguments :
1990 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001991 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1993 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1994 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1995
1996 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1997 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1998 it exceeds <length>.
1999
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002000 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2002 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2003 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002004 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2005 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2006 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2007 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002009 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2010 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2011 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2012 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2013 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
2015 Example:
2016 capture response header Content-length len 9
2017 capture response header Location len 15
2018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002019 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 about logging.
2021
2022
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002023clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | no
2027 Arguments :
2028 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2030 as explained at the top of this document.
2031
2032 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2033 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2034 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2035 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2036 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2037 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2038 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2039 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002040 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2042 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2043
2044 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2045 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2046 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2047 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2048 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2049 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2050
2051 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2052 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2053
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002054 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2055 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002057compression algo <algorithm> ...
2058compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002059compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002060 Enable HTTP compression.
2061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2062 yes | yes | yes | yes
2063 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002064 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2065 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2066 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2067
2068 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002069 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002070 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2071 data.
2072
2073 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2074 support for zlib was built in.
2075
2076 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2077 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2078 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2079 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2080 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2081 in.
2082
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002083 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002084 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002085 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2086 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2087 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2088 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2089 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002090
2091 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2092 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2093 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2094 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2095 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002096 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2097 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2098 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2099 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2100 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2101 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002102
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002103 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002104 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2105 "Accept-Encoding" header
2106 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002107 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002108 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2109 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002110 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2111 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2112 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2113 "multipart"
2114 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2115 header
2116 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2117 and later
2118 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2119 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002120
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002121 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2122 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002123
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002124 Examples :
2125 compression algo gzip
2126 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2131 yes | no | yes | yes
2132 Arguments :
2133 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2135 as explained at the top of this document.
2136
2137 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002138 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002139 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2141 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2142 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2143 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2144
2145 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2146 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2147 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2148 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2149 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2150 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2151
2152 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2153 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2154 instead.
2155
2156 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2157 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2158
2159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002160cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002161 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2162 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | no | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2168 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2169 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2170 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2171 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2172 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2173 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2174 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2175 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2176
2177 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2178 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2179 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2180 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2181 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2182 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2183 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2184 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2185 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2186 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2187 "insert" and "prefix".
2188
2189 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002190 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002191
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002192 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002193 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2194 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2195 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2196 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2197 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2198 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2199 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2200 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2201 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2202 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
2204 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2205 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2206 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2207 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2208 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2209 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2210 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2211 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2212 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2213 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002214 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2215 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2216 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002218 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2219 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2220 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002221 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2222 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2223 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2224 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002225 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2226 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2227 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
2229 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2230 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2231 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2232 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2233 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2234 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2235 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2236 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2237 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2238
2239 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2240 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2241 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2242 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2243 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2244 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2245 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2246 persistence cookie in the cache.
2247 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2248
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002249 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2250 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2251 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2252 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2253 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2254 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2255 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2256 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2257 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2258 they logout.
2259
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002260 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2261 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2262 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2263 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2264
2265 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2266 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2267 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2268 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2269 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2270 this attribute.
2271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002272 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002274 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2275 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2276 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2277 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2278 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2279 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002281 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2282 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2283 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2284 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2285 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2286 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2287 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2288 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2289 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2290 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2291 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2292 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2293 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2294 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2295 the site.
2296
2297 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2298 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2299 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2300 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2301 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2302 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2303 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2304 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2305 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2306 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2307 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2308 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2309 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2310 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2311 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2312 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2315 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2316 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2317 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319 Examples :
2320 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2321 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2322 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002323 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002325 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002326 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002329default-server [param*]
2330 Change default options for a server in a backend
2331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2332 yes | no | yes | yes
2333 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002334 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2335 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2336 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2337 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002339 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002340 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2341
2342 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345default_backend <backend>
2346 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 yes | yes | yes | no
2349 Arguments :
2350 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2351
2352 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2353 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2354 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2355 will catch all undetermined requests.
2356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 Example :
2358
2359 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2360 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2361 default_backend dynamic
2362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002363 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002366description <string>
2367 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370 Arguments : string
2371
2372 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2373 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2374 it describes.
2375 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2376
2377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378disabled
2379 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 yes | yes | yes | yes
2382 Arguments : none
2383
2384 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2385 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2386 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2387 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2388 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2389 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2390 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2391
2392 See also : "enabled"
2393
2394
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002395dispatch <address>:<port>
2396 Set a default server address
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002400
2401 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2402 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2403 during start-up.
2404
2405 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2406 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2407 possible with normal servers.
2408
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002409 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002410 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2411 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2412 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2413 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2414
2415 See also : "server"
2416
2417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418enabled
2419 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2421 yes | yes | yes | yes
2422 Arguments : none
2423
2424 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2425 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2426
2427 See also : "disabled"
2428
2429
2430errorfile <code> <file>
2431 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002436 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437
2438 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002439 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002441 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2442 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
2444 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2445 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2446 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2447
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002448 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2451 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2452 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2453 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2454
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002455 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2456 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2457 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2458 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2459 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2460 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2463 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2464 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002465 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2467
2468 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2469
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 Example :
2471 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2472 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2473 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475
2476errorloc <code> <url>
2477errorloc302 <code> <url>
2478 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 yes | yes | yes | yes
2481 Arguments :
2482 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002483 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484
2485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2490
2491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2501 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2503 request.
2504
2505 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2506
2507
2508errorloc303 <code> <url>
2509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2511 yes | yes | yes | yes
2512 Arguments :
2513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2514 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2515
2516 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2517 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2518 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2519 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2520 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2521
2522 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2523 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2524 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2525
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002526 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002528 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2529 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2530 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2531 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002532 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002533
2534 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2535
2536
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002537force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2538 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 no | yes | yes | yes
2541
2542 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2543 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2544 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2545 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2546 marked down for maintenance operations.
2547
2548 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2549 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2550 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2551 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2552 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2553 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2554 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2555 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2556 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2557
2558 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2559 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2560 is used.
2561
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002562 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002563 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002564
2565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002566fullconn <conns>
2567 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 yes | no | yes | yes
2570 Arguments :
2571 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2572 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2573
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002574 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002575 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002576 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2578 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2579 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2580 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2581 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002582 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002584 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2585 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002586 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2587 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2588 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 Example :
2591 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2592 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2593 # connections.
2594 backend dynamic
2595 fullconn 10000
2596 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2597 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2598
2599 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2600
2601
2602grace <time>
2603 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002605 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002606 Arguments :
2607 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2608 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2609 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2610
2611 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2612 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002613 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2615
2616 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2617 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2618 simplify it.
2619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002621hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002622 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2624 yes | no | yes | yes
2625 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002626 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2627 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002628
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002629 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2630 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2631 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2632 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2633 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2634 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2635 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2636 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2637 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2638 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002639
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002640 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2641 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2642 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2643 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2644 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2645 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2646 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2647 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2648 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2649 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2650 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2651 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2652 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002653 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2654 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002655
2656 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2657
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002658 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2660 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2661 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002662 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2663 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2664 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002665
2666 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2667 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002668 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2669 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2670 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2671 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2672
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002673 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2674 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2675 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2676 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2677 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2678 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2679 parameter.
2680
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002681 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2682
2683 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2684 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2685 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2686 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2687 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2688 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2689 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2690 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2691 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2692 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2693 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2694 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002695
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002696 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2697 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2698 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699
2700 See also : "balance", "server"
2701
2702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703http-check disable-on-404
2704 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 Arguments : none
2708
2709 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2710 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2711 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2712 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2713 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2714 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2715 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2716 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002717 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2718 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2719 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2720
2721 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2722
2723
2724http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002725 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002727 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002728 Arguments :
2729 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2730 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002731 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002732 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2733 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2734 details on the supported keywords.
2735
2736 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2737 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2738 with the usual backslash ('\').
2739
2740 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2741 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2742 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2743 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2744 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2745
2746 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002747 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002748 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2749 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2750 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2751
2752 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002753 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002754 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2755 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2756 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2757 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2758
2759 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002760 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002761 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2762 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2763 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2764 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2765 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2766 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2767 trace).
2768
2769 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002770 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002771 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2772 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2773 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2774 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2775 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2776 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2777
2778 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2779 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2780 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2781 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2782 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2783 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2784 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2785 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2786
2787 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2788 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2789
2790 Examples :
2791 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002792 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002793
2794 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002795 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002796
2797 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002798 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002799
2800 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002801 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002804
2805
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002806http-check send-state
2807 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2809 yes | no | yes | yes
2810 Arguments : none
2811
2812 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2813 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2814 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2815 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2816 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2817
2818 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2819 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2820 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2821 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2822 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2823 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2824 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2825 checked in multiple backends.
2826
2827 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2828 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2829
2830 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2831 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2832 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2833 one fails.
2834
2835 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2836 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2837 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2838
2839 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2840 server's queue.
2841
2842 Example of a header received by the application server :
2843 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2844 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2845
2846 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2847
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002848http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002849 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002850 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
2851 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002853 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2854
2855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2856 no | yes | yes | yes
2857
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002858 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2859 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2860 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2861 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2862 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002863
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002864 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2865 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2866 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2867
2868 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2869 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2870 are evaluated.
2871
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002872 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2873 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2874 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2875 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2876 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2877 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2878 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2879 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2880 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002881 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002882 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002884 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2885 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2886 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2887 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2888 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2889
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002890 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2891 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2892 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002893 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2894 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002895
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002896 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2897 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2898 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2899 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2900 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2901 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2902 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2903 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2904
2905 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2906 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2907 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2908 external users.
2909
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002910 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2911 <name>.
2912
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002913 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2914 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2915 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2916 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2917 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2918 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2919 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2920 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2921
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002922 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2923 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2924 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2925 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2926 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2927 another equipment.
2928
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002929 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2930 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2931 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2932 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2933 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2934 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2935 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2936 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2937
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002938 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2939 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2940 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2941 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2942 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2943 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2944 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2945 admin privileges.
2946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002947 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2948
2949 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2950 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2951 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2952 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002953
2954 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002955 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2956 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2957 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002958
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002959 http-request allow if nagios
2960 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2961 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2962 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002963
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002964 Example:
2965 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002966 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002967
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002968 Example:
2969 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2970 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2971 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2972 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2974 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2975 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2976 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2977 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2978
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002979 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2980 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002981
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002982http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002983 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
2984 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002985 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002986 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2987
2988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2989 no | yes | yes | yes
2990
2991 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2992 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2993 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2994 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2995 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2996 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2997
2998 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2999 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3000 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3001 current section.
3002
3003 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3004 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3005 rules are evaluated.
3006
3007 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3008 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3009 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3010 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3011 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3012 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3013 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3014
3015 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3016 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3017 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3018 external users.
3019
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003020 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3021 <name>.
3022
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003023 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3024 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3025 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3026 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3027 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3028 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3029 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3030 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3031
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003032 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3033 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3034 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3035 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3036 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3037 another equipment.
3038
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003039 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3040 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3041 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3042 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3043 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3044 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3045 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3046 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3047
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003048 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3050 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3051 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3052 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3053 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3054 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3055 admin privileges.
3056
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003057 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3058
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003059 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003060 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3061 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3062 rules.
3063
3064 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3065 ACL usage.
3066
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003067
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003068http-send-name-header [<header>]
3069 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3070
3071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3072 yes | no | yes | yes
3073
3074 Arguments :
3075
3076 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3077
3078 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3079 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3080 is added with the header string proved.
3081
3082 See also : "server"
3083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003084id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003085 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 no | yes | yes | yes
3088 Arguments : none
3089
3090 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3091 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3092 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003093
3094
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003095ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3096 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3098 no | yes | yes | yes
3099
3100 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3101 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3102 and running).
3103
3104 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3105 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3106 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003107 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003108 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3109
3110 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3111 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3112
3113 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3114 "unless" condition is met.
3115
3116 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3117
3118
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003119log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003120log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003121no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003122 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003125
3126 Prefix :
3127 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3128 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3129 prefix does not allow arguments.
3130
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003131 Arguments :
3132 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3133 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3134 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3135 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3136 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3137 parameter.
3138
3139 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3140 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3141
3142 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3143 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3144 standard syslog port).
3145
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003146 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3147 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3148 standard syslog port).
3149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003150 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3151 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3152 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3153 appropriately writeable).
3154
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003155 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3156 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3157 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3158 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3159
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003160 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3161
3162 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3163 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3164 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3165
3166 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3167 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3168 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003169 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3170 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3171 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3172 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3173 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003174
3175 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3176
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003177 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3178 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3179 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003180
3181 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3182 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3183 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3184 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3185
3186 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3187 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003188
3189 Example :
3190 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003191 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3192 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003193 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003196log-format <string>
3197 Allows you to custom a log line.
3198
3199 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3200
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003201
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003202max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3203 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3205 yes | no | yes | yes
3206
3207 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3208 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3209 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3210 servers.
3211
3212 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3213 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3214 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3215 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3216 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3217 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3218 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3219 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3220 picking a different server.
3221
3222 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3223 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3224 even if they have to be queued.
3225
3226 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3227 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3228
3229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230maxconn <conns>
3231 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3233 yes | yes | yes | no
3234 Arguments :
3235 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3236 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3237 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3238 closes.
3239
3240 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3241 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3242 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3243 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3244 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3245 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3246 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3247 properly tuned.
3248
3249 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3250 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3251 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3252
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003253 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003255 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3256
3257
3258mode { tcp|http|health }
3259 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3261 yes | yes | yes | yes
3262 Arguments :
3263 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3264 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3265 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3266 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3267
3268 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3269 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3270 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3271 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3272 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3273
3274 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003275 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3276 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3277 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3278 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3279 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3280 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3281 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003282
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003283 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3284 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3285 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003286
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003287 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003288 defaults http_instances
3289 mode http
3290
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003291 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003294monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003295 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 Arguments :
3299 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3300 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003301 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003302 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3303 backend and its backup.
3304
3305 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3306 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3307 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3308 servers in a list of backends.
3309
3310 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3311 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3312 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3313 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3314 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3315 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3316 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003317 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3318 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
3320 Example:
3321 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003322 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3324 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3325 monitor-uri /site_alive
3326 monitor fail if site_dead
3327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003328 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
3330
3331monitor-net <source>
3332 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 yes | yes | yes | no
3335 Arguments :
3336 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3337 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3338 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3339 followed by a mask.
3340
3341 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3342 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003343 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003344 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3345
3346 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3347 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3348 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3349 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003350 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3351 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3352 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003353
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003354 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3355 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3356 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3357 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3358 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3359 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003361 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3362 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003364 Example :
3365 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3366 frontend www
3367 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3368
3369 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3370
3371
3372monitor-uri <uri>
3373 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | yes | yes | no
3376 Arguments :
3377 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3378 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3379
3380 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3381 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3382 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3383 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3384 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3385 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3386 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3387 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3388
3389 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3390 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3391 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3392 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3393 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3394 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3395
3396 Example :
3397 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3398 frontend www
3399 mode http
3400 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3401
3402 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003405option abortonclose
3406no option abortonclose
3407 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | no | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : none
3411
3412 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3413 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3414 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3415 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003416 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003417 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3418 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3419 encountered while delivering the response.
3420
3421 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3422 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3423 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3424 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3425 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3426 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003427 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003428 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003429 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003430 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3431 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3432 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3433
3434 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3435 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3436 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3437 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3438 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3439 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3440 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3441 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003442 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003443
3444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3446
3447 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3448
3449
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003450option accept-invalid-http-request
3451no option accept-invalid-http-request
3452 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 yes | yes | yes | no
3455 Arguments : none
3456
3457 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3458 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3459 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3460 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3461 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3462 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3463 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3464 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003465 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3466 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3467 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3468 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3469 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3470 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003471
3472 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3473 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3474 been confirmed.
3475
3476 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3477 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003478 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3479 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003480 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3481
3482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3484
3485 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3486 stats socket.
3487
3488
3489option accept-invalid-http-response
3490no option accept-invalid-http-response
3491 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | no | yes | yes
3494 Arguments : none
3495
3496 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3497 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3498 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3499 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3500 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3501 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3502 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3503 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3504 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3505
3506 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3507 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3508 been confirmed.
3509
3510 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3511 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3512 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3513 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3514
3515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3517
3518 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3519 stats socket.
3520
3521
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003522option allbackups
3523no option allbackups
3524 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | no | yes | yes
3527 Arguments : none
3528
3529 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3530 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3531 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3532 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3533 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3534 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3535 order between the backup servers anymore.
3536
3537 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3538 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3539
3540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3542
3543
3544option checkcache
3545no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003546 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | no | yes | yes
3549 Arguments : none
3550
3551 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3552 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003553 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3555 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003556 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557
3558 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003559 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003560 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003561 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3562 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003563 to the client are :
3564 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003565 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003566 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003567 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3568 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3569 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3570 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3571 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3572 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3573 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3574 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3575 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3576 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3577 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3578
3579 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003580 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003581 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003582 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003583 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3584
3585 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3586 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003587 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003588 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3589
3590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3592
3593
3594option clitcpka
3595no option clitcpka
3596 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3598 yes | yes | yes | no
3599 Arguments : none
3600
3601 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3602 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3603 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3604 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3605
3606 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3607 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3608 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3609 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3610
3611 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3612 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3613 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3614 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3615 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3616
3617 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3618
3619 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3620 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3621 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3622
3623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3625
3626 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3627
3628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629option contstats
3630 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | no
3633 Arguments : none
3634
3635 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3636 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3637 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3638 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3639 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3640 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3641 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3642
3643
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003644option dontlog-normal
3645no option dontlog-normal
3646 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 yes | yes | yes | no
3649 Arguments : none
3650
3651 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3652 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3653 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3654 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3655 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3656 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3657 logged.
3658
3659 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3660 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3661 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003663 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003664 logging.
3665
3666
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003667option dontlognull
3668no option dontlognull
3669 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | yes | yes | no
3672 Arguments : none
3673
3674 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3675 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3676 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3677 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3678 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3679 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3680 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3681
3682 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3683 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3684 would not be logged.
3685
3686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003689 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003690
3691
3692option forceclose
3693no option forceclose
3694 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003696 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697 Arguments : none
3698
3699 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3700 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3701 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3702 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3703 global session times in the logs.
3704
3705 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003706 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003707 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003708
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003709 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3710 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3711 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3712
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003713 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3714 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003715
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3718
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003719 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003720
3721
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003722option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003723 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | yes | yes | yes
3726 Arguments :
3727 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3728 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003729 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003730 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003731
3732 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3733 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3734 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3735 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3736 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3737 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3738 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003739 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3740 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3741 possible that the client has already brought one.
3742
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003743 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003744 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003745 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3746 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003747 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3748 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003749
3750 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3751 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3752 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3753 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3754 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3755 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3756 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3757
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003758 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3759 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3760 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3761 are under the control of the end-user.
3762
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003763 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003764 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3765 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003766 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3767 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3768 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003769
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003770 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003771 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3772 frontend www
3773 mode http
3774 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3775
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003776 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3777 backend www
3778 mode http
3779 option forwardfor header X-Client
3780
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003781 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003782 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003783
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003784
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003785option http-keep-alive
3786no option http-keep-alive
3787 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | yes | yes | yes
3790 Arguments : none
3791
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003792 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3793 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3794 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3795 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3796 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3797 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3798 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3799
3800 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3801 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003802 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3803 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3804 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3805 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3806 situations where this option may be useful :
3807
3808 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3809 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3810
3811 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3812 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3813
3814 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3815 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3816 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3817 request.
3818
3819 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3820 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003821 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3822 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3823 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003824
3825 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3826 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3827
3828 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3829 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3830 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3831 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3832 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3833 not set.
3834
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003835 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3836 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003837 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003838 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003839
3840 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003841 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3842 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003843
3844
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003845option http-no-delay
3846no option http-no-delay
3847 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3849 yes | yes | yes | yes
3850 Arguments : none
3851
3852 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3853 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3854 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3855 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3856 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3857 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3858 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3859 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3860 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3861 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3862 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3863 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3864 affected.
3865
3866 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3867 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3868 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3869 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3870 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3871 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3872 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3873 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3874 latency environments.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003877option http-pretend-keepalive
3878no option http-pretend-keepalive
3879 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | yes | yes | yes
3882 Arguments : none
3883
3884 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3885 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3886 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3887 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3888 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3889 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3890 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3891 consider the response complete.
3892
3893 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3894 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3895 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3896 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3897 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3898 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3899
3900 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3901 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3902 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3903 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3904 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3905 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3906 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3907
3908 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3909 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003910 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003911 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3912 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003913
3914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3916
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003917 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3918 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003919
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003920
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003921option http-server-close
3922no option http-server-close
3923 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | yes
3926 Arguments : none
3927
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003928 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3929 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3930 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
3931 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
3932 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3933 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
3934 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
3935 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
3936 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
3937 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
3938 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
3939 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
3940 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
3941 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
3942 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
3943 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003944
3945 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3946 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3947 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3948 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003949 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3950 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003951
3952 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3953 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003954 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
3955 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003956 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
3957 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003958
3959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3961
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003962 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003963 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3964 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003965
3966
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003967option http-tunnel
3968no option http-tunnel
3969 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
3970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3971 yes | yes | yes | yes
3972 Arguments : none
3973
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003974 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3975 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3976 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
3977 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
3978 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3979 "option http-tunnel".
3980
3981 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003982 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003983 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
3984 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
3985 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
3986 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
3987 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
3988 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
3989 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003990
3991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3993
3994 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
3995 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3996 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
3997
3998
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003999option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004000no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004001 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | no
4004 Arguments : none
4005
4006 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4007 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4008 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4009 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4010 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4011 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4012 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4013
4014 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4015 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4016 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4017 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4018 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4019 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4020 request along its whole life.
4021
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004022 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4023 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4024 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4025 front of an existing proxy.
4026
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004027 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4028
4029 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4030 http-server-close".
4031
4032
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004033option httpchk
4034option httpchk <uri>
4035option httpchk <method> <uri>
4036option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4037 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | no | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4042 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4043 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4044 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4045 ones.
4046
4047 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4048 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4049 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4050
4051 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4052 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4053 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4054 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4055 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4056
4057 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4058 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4059 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4060 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4061 the lack of any response.
4062
4063 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4064
4065 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4066 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4067 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4068
4069 Examples :
4070 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4071 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4072 backend https_relay
4073 mode tcp
4074 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4075 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4076
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004077 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4078 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4079 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004080
4081
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004082option httpclose
4083no option httpclose
4084 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | yes | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004089 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4090 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4091 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4092 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004093 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004094 "option http-tunnel".
4095
4096 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4097 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4098 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4099 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4100 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4101 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4102 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4103 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004104
4105 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004106 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004107 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4108 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4109 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4110 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4111 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004112
4113 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4114 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004115 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4116 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004117 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4118 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004119
4120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4122
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004123 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4124 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004125
4126
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004127option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004128 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004131 Arguments :
4132 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4133 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4134 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4135 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4136 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004137
4138 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4139 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4140 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4141 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4142 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4143 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4144 ports.
4145
4146 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4147
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4150 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4151 by default.
4152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004153 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004155
4156option http_proxy
4157no option http_proxy
4158 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 yes | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments : none
4162
4163 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4164 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4165 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4166 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4167 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4168
4169 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4170 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4171 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4172 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004173 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004174 be analyzed.
4175
4176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4178
4179 Example :
4180 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4181 backend direct_forward
4182 option httpclose
4183 option http_proxy
4184
4185 See also : "option httpclose"
4186
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004187
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004188option independent-streams
4189no option independent-streams
4190 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | yes
4193 Arguments : none
4194
4195 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4196 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4197 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4198 receive data or not.
4199
4200 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4201 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4202 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4203 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4204 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4205 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4206 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4207 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4208 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4209 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4210 socket buffers.
4211
4212 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4213 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4214 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4215 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4216 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4217
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004218 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004219 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4220 deprecated.
4221
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004222 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004223
4224
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004225option ldap-check
4226 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 yes | no | yes | yes
4229 Arguments : none
4230
4231 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4232 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4233 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4234 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4235
4236 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4237 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4238
4239 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4240 configure it.
4241
4242 Example :
4243 option ldap-check
4244
4245 See also : "option httpchk"
4246
4247
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004248option log-health-checks
4249no option log-health-checks
4250 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | no | yes | yes
4253 Arguments : none
4254
4255 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4256 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4257 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4258 of additional information is limited.
4259
4260 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4261 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4262
4263 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4264
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004265
4266option log-separate-errors
4267no option log-separate-errors
4268 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 yes | yes | yes | no
4271 Arguments : none
4272
4273 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4274 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4275 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4276 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4277 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4278 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4279 provides very important information.
4280
4281 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4282 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4283 error logs.
4284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004285 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004286 logging.
4287
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004288
4289option logasap
4290no option logasap
4291 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 yes | yes | yes | no
4294 Arguments : none
4295
4296 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4297 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4298 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4299 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4300 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4301 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4302 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004303 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004304 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4305 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004307 Examples :
4308 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4309 mode http
4310 option httplog
4311 option logasap
4312 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4313
4314 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4315 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4316 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4317 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004319 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004320 logging.
4321
4322
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004323option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4324 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004327 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004328 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4329 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004330
4331 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4332 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4333 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4334 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4335 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4336 in the MySQL table, like this :
4337
4338 USE mysql;
4339 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4340 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4341
4342 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4343 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4344 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4345 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4346 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4347 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4348 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4349 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4350 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4351
4352 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4353 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004354
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004355 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004356
4357 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4358 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4359 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4360 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4361 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4362 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4363
4364 See also: "option httpchk"
4365
4366
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004367option nolinger
4368no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004369 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004372 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004373
4374 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4375 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4376 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4377 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4378 connections.
4379
4380 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4381 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4382 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4383 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4384 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4385 this too.
4386
4387 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4388 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4389 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4390
4391 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4392 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4393 for servers.
4394
4395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4397
4398
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004399option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4400 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | yes
4403 Arguments :
4404 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4405 matching <network>
4406 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4407 header name.
4408
4409 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4410 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4411 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4412 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4413 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4414 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4415 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4416 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4417 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4418 possible that the client has already brought one.
4419
4420 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4421 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4422 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4423 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4424 header and requires different one.
4425
4426 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4427 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4428 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4429 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4430 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4431 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4432 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4433
4434 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4435 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4436 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4437 both are defined.
4438
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004439 Examples :
4440 # Original Destination address
4441 frontend www
4442 mode http
4443 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4444
4445 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4446 backend www
4447 mode http
4448 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4449
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004450 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4451 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004452
4453
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004454option persist
4455no option persist
4456 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004459 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004460
4461 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4462 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4463 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4464 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4465 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4466 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4467 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4468 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4469 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4470 redirected to another valid server.
4471
4472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4474
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004475 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004476
4477
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004478option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4479 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482 Arguments :
4483 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4484 PostgreSQL server.
4485
4486 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4487 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4488 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4489 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4490
4491 See also: "option httpchk"
4492
4493
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004494option prefer-last-server
4495no option prefer-last-server
4496 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | no | yes | yes
4499 Arguments : none
4500
4501 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4502 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4503 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4504 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4505 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4506 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4507 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4508 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4509 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004510 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4511 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4512 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4513 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4514 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4515 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4516 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004517
4518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4520
4521 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4522
4523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004524option redispatch
4525no option redispatch
4526 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4528 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004529 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004530
4531 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4532 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4533 be able to access the service anymore.
4534
4535 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4536 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4537
4538 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4539 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4540 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004542 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4543 "redisp" keywords.
4544
4545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4547
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004548 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004549
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004550
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004551option redis-check
4552 Use redis health checks for server testing
4553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | no | yes | yes
4555 Arguments : none
4556
4557 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4558 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4559 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4560 find the "+PONG" response message.
4561
4562 Example :
4563 option redis-check
4564
4565 See also : "option httpchk"
4566
4567
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004568option smtpchk
4569option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4570 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004573 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004574 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4575 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4576 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4577
4578 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4579 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4580 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4581
4582 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4583 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4584 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4585 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4586 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4587 dead server.
4588
4589 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4590 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4591 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4592 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4593
4594 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4595 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4596 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4597 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4598 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4599
4600 Example :
4601 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4602
4603 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004606option socket-stats
4607no option socket-stats
4608
4609 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | no
4612
4613 Arguments : none
4614
4615
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004616option splice-auto
4617no option splice-auto
4618 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | yes
4621 Arguments : none
4622
4623 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4624 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4625 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4626 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004627 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004628 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4629 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4630 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4631 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4632
4633 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4634 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4635 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4636 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4637 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4638 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4639 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4640 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4641 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4642 keyword.
4643
4644 Example :
4645 option splice-auto
4646
4647 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4648 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4649
4650 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4651 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4652
4653
4654option splice-request
4655no option splice-request
4656 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | yes | yes | yes
4659 Arguments : none
4660
4661 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004662 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004663 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4664 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4665 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4666 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4667
4668 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4669
4670 Example :
4671 option splice-request
4672
4673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4675
4676 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4677 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4678
4679
4680option splice-response
4681no option splice-response
4682 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : none
4686
4687 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004688 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004689 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4690 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4691 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4692 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4693
4694 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4695
4696 Example :
4697 option splice-response
4698
4699 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4700 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4701
4702 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4703 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4704
4705
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004706option srvtcpka
4707no option srvtcpka
4708 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 yes | no | yes | yes
4711 Arguments : none
4712
4713 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4714 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4715 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4716 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4717
4718 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4719 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4720 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4721 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4722
4723 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4724 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4725 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4726 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4727 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4728
4729 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4730
4731 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4732 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4733 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4734
4735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4737
4738 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4739
4740
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004741option ssl-hello-chk
4742 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 yes | no | yes | yes
4745 Arguments : none
4746
4747 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4748 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4749 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4750 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4751 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4752 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4753 hello message.
4754
4755 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4756 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4757 messages, which is appreciable.
4758
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004759 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4760 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4761 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004762
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004763 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4764
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004765
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004766option tcp-check
4767 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 yes | no | yes | yes
4770
4771 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4772 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4773
4774 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4775 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4776 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4777
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004778 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004779 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4780 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4781 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4782 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4783 only.
4784
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004785 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004786 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4787 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4788 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4789 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4790
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004791 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004792 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4793 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004794 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004795 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4796 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4797 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4798 the respective protocols.
4799 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4800 analysed.
4801
4802 Examples :
4803 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4804 option tcp-check
4805 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4806
4807 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4808 option tcp-check
4809 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4810
4811 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4812 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004813 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004814 option tcp-check
4815 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4816 tcp-check expect +PONG
4817 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4818 tcp-check expect string role:master
4819 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4820 tcp-check expect string +OK
4821
4822 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4823 (send many headers before analyzing)
4824 option tcp-check
4825 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4826 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4827 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4828 tcp-check send \r\n
4829 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4830
4831
4832 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4833
4834
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004835option tcp-smart-accept
4836no option tcp-smart-accept
4837 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | yes | yes | no
4840 Arguments : none
4841
4842 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4843 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4844 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4845 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4846 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4847 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4848
4849 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4850 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4851 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4852 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4853
4854 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4855 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4856 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4857 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4858
4859 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4860 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4861 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4862
4863 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4864 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4865 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4866
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004867 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4868
4869
4870option tcp-smart-connect
4871no option tcp-smart-connect
4872 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | no | yes | yes
4875 Arguments : none
4876
4877 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4878 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4879 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4880 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4881 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4882
4883 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4884 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4885 complex.
4886
4887 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4888 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4889 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4890
4891 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4892 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4893
4894 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4895
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004896
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004897option tcpka
4898 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4900 yes | yes | yes | yes
4901 Arguments : none
4902
4903 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4904 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4905 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4906 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4907
4908 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4909 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4910 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4911 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4912
4913 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4914 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4915 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4916 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4917 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4918
4919 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4920
4921 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4922 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4923 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4924 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4925 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4926 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4927 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4928 backends.
4929
4930 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4931
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004932
4933option tcplog
4934 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4936 yes | yes | yes | yes
4937 Arguments : none
4938
4939 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4940 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4941 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4942 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4943 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4944 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4945 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4946 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4947
4948 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004950 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004951
4952
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004953option transparent
4954no option transparent
4955 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004957 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004958 Arguments : none
4959
4960 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4961 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4962 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4963 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4964 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4965 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4966 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4967 appropriate server.
4968
4969 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4970 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4971
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004972 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004973 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004974
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004975
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004976persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004977persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004978 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | no | yes | yes
4981 Arguments :
4982 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004983 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4984 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004985
4986 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4987 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4988 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4989 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4990 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4991 forwarded to this server.
4992
4993 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4994 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4995 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004996 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004997 a single "listen" section.
4998
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004999 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5000 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5001 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5002
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005003 Example :
5004 listen tse-farm
5005 bind :3389
5006 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5007 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5008 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5009 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5010 persist rdp-cookie
5011 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005012 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005013 balance rdp-cookie
5014 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5015 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5016
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005017 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5018 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005019
5020
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005021rate-limit sessions <rate>
5022 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | yes | yes | no
5025 Arguments :
5026 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5027 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5028
5029 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5030 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5031 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5032 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5033 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5034 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5035
5036 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5037 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5038 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5039 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5040
5041 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5042 listen smtp
5043 mode tcp
5044 bind :25
5045 rate-limit sessions 10
5046 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5047
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005048 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5049 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5050 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005051
5052 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5053
5054
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005055redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5056redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5057redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005058 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 no | yes | yes | yes
5061
5062 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005063 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005064
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005065 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005066 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005067 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5068 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5069 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005070
5071 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5072 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5073 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5074 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5075 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005076 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5077 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5078 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5079 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005080
5081 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5082 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5083 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5084 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5085 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5086 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005087 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005088 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005089 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5090 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5091 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005092
5093 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005094 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5095 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5096 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5097 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5098 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5099 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5100 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5101 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005102
5103 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5104 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5105
5106 - "drop-query"
5107 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5108 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5109 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5110 with a location-type redirect.
5111
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005112 - "append-slash"
5113 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5114 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5115 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5116 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5117
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005118 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5119 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5120 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5121 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5122 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5123 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5124 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5125
5126 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5127 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5128 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5129 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5130 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5131 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5132 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005133
5134 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5135 acl clear dst_port 80
5136 acl secure dst_port 8080
5137 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005138 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005139 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005140 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5141
5142 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005143 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5144 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5145 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005146 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005147
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005148 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5149 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5150 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5151
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005152 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005153 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005154
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005155 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5156 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5157 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005159 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005160
5161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005162redisp (deprecated)
5163redispatch (deprecated)
5164 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5166 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005167 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005168
5169 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5170 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5171 be able to access the service anymore.
5172
5173 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5174 redistribute them to a working server.
5175
5176 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5177 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5178 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005180 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5181 "option redispatch" instead.
5182
5183 See also : "option redispatch"
5184
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005185
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005186reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005187 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5189 no | yes | yes | yes
5190 Arguments :
5191 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5192 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005193 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005194
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005195 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5196 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5197
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005198 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5199 the last header of an HTTP request.
5200
5201 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5202 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5203 responses.
5204
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005205 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5206 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5207 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5208
5209 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5210 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005211
5212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005213reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5214reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005215 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5217 no | yes | yes | yes
5218 Arguments :
5219 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5220 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5221 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5222 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5223 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5224 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5225 ignores case.
5226
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005227 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5228 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5229
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005230 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5231 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5232 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5233 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005234 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005235
5236 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5237 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5238
5239 Example :
5240 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5241 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5242 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005244 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5245 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005246
5247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005248reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5249reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005250 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 no | yes | yes | yes
5253 Arguments :
5254 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5255 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5256 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5257 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5258 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5259 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5260
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005261 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5262 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5263
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005264 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5265 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5266 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5267 next servers.
5268
5269 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5270 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5271 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5272
5273 Example :
5274 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5275 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5276 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5277
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005278 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5279 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005280
5281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005282reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5283reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005284 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 no | yes | yes | yes
5287 Arguments :
5288 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5289 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5290 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5291 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5292 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5293 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5294 case.
5295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005296 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5297 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5298
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005299 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5300 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5301 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5302 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005303 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005304
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005305 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005306 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005307 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005308
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005309 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5310 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5311
5312 Example :
5313 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5314 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5315 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005317 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5318 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005319
5320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005321reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5322reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005323 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 no | yes | yes | yes
5326 Arguments :
5327 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5328 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5329 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5330 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5331 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5332 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5333 case.
5334
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005338 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5339 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5340 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5341 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5342
5343 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5344 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5345
5346 Example :
5347 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5348 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5349 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5350 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005352 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5353 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005354
5355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005356reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5357reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005358 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 no | yes | yes | yes
5361 Arguments :
5362 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5363 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5364 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5365 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5366 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5367 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5368
5369 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5370 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5371 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5372 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005373 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005378 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5379 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5380 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5381
5382 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5383 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5384 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5385 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5386 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5387
5388 Example :
5389 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005390 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005391 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5392 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5393
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005394 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5395 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005396
5397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005398reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5399reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005400 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 no | yes | yes | yes
5403 Arguments :
5404 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5405 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5406 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5407 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5408 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5409 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5410 ignores case.
5411
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005412 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5413 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5414
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005415 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5416 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005417 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5418 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5419 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005420 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5421 not set.
5422
5423 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5424 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5425 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5426 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5427 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5428
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005429 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005430 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5431 # block all others.
5432 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5433 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005435 # block bad guys
5436 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5437 reqitarpit . if badguys
5438
5439 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5440 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005441
5442
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005443retries <value>
5444 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | no | yes | yes
5447 Arguments :
5448 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5449 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5450 default value is 3.
5451
5452 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5453 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5454 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5455
5456 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5457 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5458
5459 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5460 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5461
5462 See also : "option redispatch"
5463
5464
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005465rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005466 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 no | yes | yes | yes
5469 Arguments :
5470 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5471 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005472 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005473
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005474 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5475 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5476
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005477 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5478 the last header of an HTTP response.
5479
5480 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5481 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5482 responses.
5483
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005484 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5485 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486
5487
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005488rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5489rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5492 no | yes | yes | yes
5493 Arguments :
5494 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5495 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5496 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5497 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5498 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5499 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5500 ignores case.
5501
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005502 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5503 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005505 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5506 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005507 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508 client.
5509
5510 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5511 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5512 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5513
5514 Example :
5515 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005516 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005517
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005518 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5519 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005520
5521
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005522rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5523rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005524 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5526 no | yes | yes | yes
5527 Arguments :
5528 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5529 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5530 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5531 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5532 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5533 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5534 ignores case.
5535
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005536 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5537 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5538
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005539 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5540 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5541 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5542 case-sensitive.
5543
5544 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005545 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5546 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5547 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005548
5549 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5550 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5551
5552 Example :
5553 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5554 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5555
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005556 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5557 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005558
5559
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005560rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5561rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005562 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5564 no | yes | yes | yes
5565 Arguments :
5566 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5567 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5568 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5569 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5570 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5571 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5572 ignores case.
5573
5574 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5575 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5576 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5577 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005578 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005580 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5581 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5582
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5584 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5585 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5586
5587 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5588 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5589 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5590 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5591 are not case-sensitive.
5592
5593 Example :
5594 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5595 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5596
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005597 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5598 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599
5600
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005601server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005602 Declare a server in a backend
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 no | no | yes | yes
5605 Arguments :
5606 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005607 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005608 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005609
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005610 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5611 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5612 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5613 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005614 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5615 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5616 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5617 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5618 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005619 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5620 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5621 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5622 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5623 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5624 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5625 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005626 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5627 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5628 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5629 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005630
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005631 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005632 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5633 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5634 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5635 adding this value to the client's port.
5636
5637 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5638 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005639 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005640
5641 Examples :
5642 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5643 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005644 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005645 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5646 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5647 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005648
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005649 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5650 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005651
5652
5653source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005654source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005655source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005656 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
5659 Arguments :
5660 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5661 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005662
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005663 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005664 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5665 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5666 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5667 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5668 supported prefixes are :
5669 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5670 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5671 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005672 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5673 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5674 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5675 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005676
5677 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5678 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005679 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5680 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5681 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005682
5683 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5684 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5685 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5686 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5687 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5688 <addr>.
5689
5690 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5691 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5692 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5693 port.
5694
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005695 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5696 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5697 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5698 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005699 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005700 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5701 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5702 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5703 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5704 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5705 HTTP header.
5706
5707 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5708 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005709 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005710 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5711 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5712 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5713 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5714 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5715 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5716 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5717
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005718 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5719 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5720 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5721 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5722 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5723 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005725 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5726 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5727 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5728 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5729
5730 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5731 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5732 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5733 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5734 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5735 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5736
5737 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5738 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5739 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5740 there are two methods :
5741
5742 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5743 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5744 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5745 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5746 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5747 of the client ranges may be used.
5748
5749 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5750 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5751 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5752 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5753 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5754 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5755 same session.
5756
5757 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5758 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5759 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5760 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5761 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5762 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5763
5764 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5765 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5766 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005767 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005768
5769 Examples :
5770 backend private
5771 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5772 source 192.168.1.200
5773
5774 backend transparent_ssl1
5775 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5776 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5777
5778 backend transparent_ssl2
5779 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5780 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5781 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5782
5783 backend transparent_ssl3
5784 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5785 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5786 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5787
5788 backend transparent_smtp
5789 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5790 # with Tproxy version 4.
5791 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5792
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005793 backend transparent_http
5794 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5795 # proxy.
5796 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005798 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005799 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005801
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005802srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5803 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
5806 Arguments :
5807 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5809 as explained at the top of this document.
5810
5811 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5812 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5813 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5814 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5815 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5816 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5817 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5818
5819 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5820 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5821 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5822 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5823 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005824 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005825 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005826 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005827
5828 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5829 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5830 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5831 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5832 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5833 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5834
5835 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5836 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5837
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005838 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5839 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005840
5841
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005842stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5843 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005845 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005846
5847 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5848 matched.
5849
5850 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5851 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5852
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005853 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5854 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5855 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5856
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005857 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5858 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5859 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5860 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005861
5862 Example :
5863 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5864 backend stats_localhost
5865 stats enable
5866 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5867
5868 Example :
5869 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5870 backend stats_auth
5871 stats enable
5872 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5873 stats admin if TRUE
5874
5875 Example :
5876 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5877 userlist stats-auth
5878 group admin users admin
5879 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5880 group readonly users haproxy
5881 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5882
5883 backend stats_auth
5884 stats enable
5885 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5886 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5887 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5888 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5889
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005890 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5891 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5892 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005893
5894
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005895stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5896 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005899 Arguments :
5900 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5901
5902 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5903
5904 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5905 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5906 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5907 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5908 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5909 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5910
5911 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5912 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5913 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005914 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005915
5916 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5917 report using "stats scope".
5918
5919 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5920 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5921 unobvious parameters.
5922
5923 Example :
5924 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5925 backend public_www
5926 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5927 stats enable
5928 stats hide-version
5929 stats scope .
5930 stats uri /admin?stats
5931 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5932 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5933 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5934
5935 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5936 backend private_monitoring
5937 stats enable
5938 stats uri /admin?stats
5939 stats refresh 5s
5940
5941 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5942
5943
5944stats enable
5945 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005947 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005948 Arguments : none
5949
5950 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5951 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5952 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5953 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5954 - stats auth : no authentication
5955 - stats scope : no restriction
5956
5957 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5958 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5959 unobvious parameters.
5960
5961 Example :
5962 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5963 backend public_www
5964 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5965 stats enable
5966 stats hide-version
5967 stats scope .
5968 stats uri /admin?stats
5969 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5970 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5971 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5972
5973 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5974 backend private_monitoring
5975 stats enable
5976 stats uri /admin?stats
5977 stats refresh 5s
5978
5979 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5980
5981
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005982stats hide-version
5983 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005986 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005988 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5989 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5990 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5991 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5992 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5993 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005995 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5996 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5997 unobvious parameters.
5998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005999 Example :
6000 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6001 backend public_www
6002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006003 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006004 stats hide-version
6005 stats scope .
6006 stats uri /admin?stats
6007 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6008 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6009 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006010
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006011 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6012 backend private_monitoring
6013 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006014 stats uri /admin?stats
6015 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006017 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006018
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006019
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006020stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6022 Access control for statistics
6023
6024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6025 no | no | yes | yes
6026
6027 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6028 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6029 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6030 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6031 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6032 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6033
6034 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6035 instance.
6036
6037 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6038 about ACL usage.
6039
6040
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006041stats realm <realm>
6042 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006045 Arguments :
6046 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6047 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6048 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6049
6050 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6051 using a backslash ('\').
6052
6053 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6054 only related to authentication.
6055
6056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6058 unobvious parameters.
6059
6060 Example :
6061 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6062 backend public_www
6063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6064 stats enable
6065 stats hide-version
6066 stats scope .
6067 stats uri /admin?stats
6068 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6069 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6070 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6071
6072 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6073 backend private_monitoring
6074 stats enable
6075 stats uri /admin?stats
6076 stats refresh 5s
6077
6078 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6079
6080
6081stats refresh <delay>
6082 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006084 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006085 Arguments :
6086 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6087 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6088 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6089 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6090 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6091 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6092
6093 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6094 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6095 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6096 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6097
6098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6100 unobvious parameters.
6101
6102 Example :
6103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6104 backend public_www
6105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6106 stats enable
6107 stats hide-version
6108 stats scope .
6109 stats uri /admin?stats
6110 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6113
6114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6115 backend private_monitoring
6116 stats enable
6117 stats uri /admin?stats
6118 stats refresh 5s
6119
6120 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6121
6122
6123stats scope { <name> | "." }
6124 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006127 Arguments :
6128 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6129 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6130 section in which the statement appears.
6131
6132 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6133 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6134 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6135 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6136 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6137 exists.
6138
6139 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6140 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6141 unobvious parameters.
6142
6143 Example :
6144 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6145 backend public_www
6146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6147 stats enable
6148 stats hide-version
6149 stats scope .
6150 stats uri /admin?stats
6151 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6152 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6153 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6154
6155 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6156 backend private_monitoring
6157 stats enable
6158 stats uri /admin?stats
6159 stats refresh 5s
6160
6161 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006163
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006164stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006165 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006168
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006169 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006170 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6171
6172 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6173 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6174
6175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006177 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006178
6179 Example :
6180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6181 backend private_monitoring
6182 stats enable
6183 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6184 stats uri /admin?stats
6185 stats refresh 5s
6186
6187 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6188 global section.
6189
6190
6191stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006192 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | yes | yes | yes
6195 Arguments : none
6196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006197 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006198 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6199 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6200 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6201 - IP (socket, server)
6202 - cookie (backend, server)
6203
6204 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6205 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006206 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006207
6208 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6209
6210
6211stats show-node [ <name> ]
6212 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006214 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006215 Arguments:
6216 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6217 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6218
6219 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6220 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006221 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006222
6223 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6224 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6225 unobvious parameters.
6226
6227 Example:
6228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6229 backend private_monitoring
6230 stats enable
6231 stats show-node Europe-1
6232 stats uri /admin?stats
6233 stats refresh 5s
6234
6235 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6236 section.
6237
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006238
6239stats uri <prefix>
6240 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006243 Arguments :
6244 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6245 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6246 query string.
6247
6248 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6249 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6250 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6251 possible to reach it in the application.
6252
6253 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006254 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006255 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6256 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6257 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6258 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6259
6260 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6261 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6262 an address or a port to statistics only.
6263
6264 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6265 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6266 unobvious parameters.
6267
6268 Example :
6269 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6270 backend public_www
6271 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6272 stats enable
6273 stats hide-version
6274 stats scope .
6275 stats uri /admin?stats
6276 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6277 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6278 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6279
6280 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6281 backend private_monitoring
6282 stats enable
6283 stats uri /admin?stats
6284 stats refresh 5s
6285
6286 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6287
6288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006289stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6290 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006292 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006293
6294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006295 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006296 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6297 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6298 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6299
6300 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6301 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6302 the "stick-table" statement.
6303
6304 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6305 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6306 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6307 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6308 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6309
6310 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6311 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6312 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6313 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6314 transformation rules.
6315
6316 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6317 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6318 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6319 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6320 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6321 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6322 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6323
6324 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6325 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6326 ACL based conditions.
6327
6328 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6329 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6330 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6331 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6332
6333 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6334 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6335 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6336 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6337
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006338 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6339 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6340 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006342 Example :
6343 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6344 # last 30 minutes
6345 backend pop
6346 mode tcp
6347 balance roundrobin
6348 stick store-request src
6349 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6350 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6351 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6352
6353 backend smtp
6354 mode tcp
6355 balance roundrobin
6356 stick match src table pop
6357 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6358 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6359
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006360 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6361 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006362
6363
6364stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6365 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6367 no | no | yes | yes
6368
6369 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6370 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6371 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6372 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6373
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006374 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6375 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6376 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6377
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006378 Examples :
6379 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006380 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006381
6382 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6383 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6384 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6385
6386
6387 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6388 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6389 backend http
6390 mode http
6391 balance roundrobin
6392 stick on src table https
6393 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6394 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6395 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6396
6397 backend https
6398 mode tcp
6399 balance roundrobin
6400 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6401 stick on src
6402 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6403 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006405 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006406
6407
6408stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6409 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6411 no | no | yes | yes
6412
6413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006414 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006415 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6416 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6417 server is selected.
6418
6419 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6420 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6421 the "stick-table" statement.
6422
6423 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6424 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6425 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6426 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6427 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6428 address.
6429
6430 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6431 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6432 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6433 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6434 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6435 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6436 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6437 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6438 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6439 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6440
6441 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6442 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6443 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6444 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6445 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6446 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6447 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6448
6449 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6450 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6451 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6452 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6453
6454 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6455 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6456 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6457 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6458 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6459 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006460 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6461 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6462 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6463 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6464 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6465 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006466
6467 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6468 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6469 the request.
6470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006471 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6472 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6473 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6474
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006475 Example :
6476 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6477 # last 30 minutes
6478 backend pop
6479 mode tcp
6480 balance roundrobin
6481 stick store-request src
6482 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6483 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6484 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6485
6486 backend smtp
6487 mode tcp
6488 balance roundrobin
6489 stick match src table pop
6490 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6491 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006493 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6494 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006495
6496
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006497stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006498 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6499 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006500 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006502 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006503
6504 Arguments :
6505 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6506 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6507 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6508 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6509
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006510 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6511 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6512 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6513 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006515 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6516 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6517 instance.
6518
6519 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6520 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6521 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6522 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6523 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6524 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006525 to 32 characters.
6526
6527 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6528 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6529 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6530 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6531 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6532 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006533
6534 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006535 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6536 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006537 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6538 increase.
6539
6540 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006541 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6542 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6543 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006544
6545 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6546 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6547 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6548 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6549 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6550 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6551 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6552 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6553 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6554 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6555 parameter (see below).
6556
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006557 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6558 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6559 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6560 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6561 soft restart.
6562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006563 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6564
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006565 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6566 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6567 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6568 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6569 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006570 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006571 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6572 if not expiration delay is specified.
6573
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006574 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6575 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6576 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6577 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006578 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6579 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6580 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6581 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6582 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6583 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6584 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6585 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6586 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6587 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6588 types and their arguments.
6589
6590 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6591 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6592 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6593 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6594
6595 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6596 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6597 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6598 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6599
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006600 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6601 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6602 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6603 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6604 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6605 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6606
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006607 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6608 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6609 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6610 they were received.
6611
6612 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6613 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6614 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6615 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6616 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6617
6618 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6619 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6620 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6621 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6622 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6623
6624 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6625 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6626 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6627
6628 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6629 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6630 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6631 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6632 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6633
6634 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6635 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6636 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6637 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6638 the client side.
6639
6640 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6641 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6642 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6643 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6644 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6645 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6646 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6647
6648 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6649 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6650 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6651 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6652 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6653 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6654 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6655
6656 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6657 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6658 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6659 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6660 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6661 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6662
6663 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6664 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6665 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6666 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6667
6668 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6669 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6670 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6671 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6672 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6673 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6674 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6675 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6676 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6677 recommended for better fairness.
6678
6679 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6680 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6681 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6682 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6683
6684 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6685 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6686 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6687 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6688 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6689 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6690 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6691 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6692 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6693 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006694
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006695 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6696 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006697 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6698 reference it.
6699
6700 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6701 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6702 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6703 as an exclusive stickiness.
6704
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006705 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6706 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6707 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6708 something that can be ignored.
6709
6710 Example:
6711 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6712 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6713 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6714 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6715
6716 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006717 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006718
6719
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006720stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6721 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6723 no | no | yes | yes
6724
6725 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006726 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006727 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6728 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6729 server is selected.
6730
6731 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6732 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6733 the "stick-table" statement.
6734
6735 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6736 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6737 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6738 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6739
6740 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6741 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6742 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6743 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6744 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6745 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006746 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006747 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6748 rules.
6749
6750 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6751 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6752 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6753 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6754 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6755 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6756 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6757
6758 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6759 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6760 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6761 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6762
6763 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6764 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6765 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6766 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6767 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6768 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006769 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6770 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6771 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6772 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6773 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6774 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6775 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6776 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6777 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006778
6779 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6780
6781 Example :
6782 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6783 backend https
6784 mode tcp
6785 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006786 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006787 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006788
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006789 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6790 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6791
6792 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6793 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6794 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6795
6796 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6797 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006798
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006799 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6800 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6801 # at offset 44.
6802
6803 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6804 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6805
6806 # Learn on response if server hello.
6807 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006808
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006809 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6810 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6811
6812 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6813 extraction.
6814
6815
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006816tcp-check connect [params*]
6817 Opens a new connection
6818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6819 no | no | yes | yes
6820
6821 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6822 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6823 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6824
6825 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6826 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6827 of the sequence.
6828
6829 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6830 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6831 do.
6832
6833 Parameters :
6834 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6835 use the TCP connection.
6836
6837 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6838 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6839 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6840
6841 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6842
6843 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6844
6845 Examples:
6846 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6847 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6848 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6849 option tcp-check
6850 tcp-check connect
6851 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6852 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6853 tcp-check send \r\n
6854 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6855 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6856 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6857 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6858 tcp-check send \r\n
6859 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6860 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6861
6862 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
6863 option tcp-check
6864 tcp-check connect port 110
6865 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6866 tcp-check connect port 143
6867 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
6868 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
6869
6870 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
6871
6872
6873tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
6874 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
6875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 no | no | yes | yes
6877
6878 Arguments :
6879 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
6880 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
6881 binary.
6882 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
6883 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
6884 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
6885
6886 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
6887 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
6888 with the usual backslash ('\').
6889 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
6890 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
6891 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
6892 used upper or lower case.
6893
6894
6895 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
6896
6897 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
6898 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6899 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
6900 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6901 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6902 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
6903 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
6904 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
6905
6906 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
6907 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6908 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
6909 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6910 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
6911 expression.
6912
6913 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
6914 in the response buffer. A health check response will
6915 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
6916 this exact hexadecimal string.
6917 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
6918
6919 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
6920 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
6921 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6922 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
6923 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6924 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6925 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6926 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
6927 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
6928 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
6929 the null character.
6930
6931 Examples :
6932 # perform a POP check
6933 option tcp-check
6934 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6935
6936 # perform an IMAP check
6937 option tcp-check
6938 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
6939
6940 # look for the redis master server
6941 option tcp-check
6942 tcp-check send PING\r\n
6943 tcp-check expect +PONG
6944 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6945 tcp-check expect string role:master
6946 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6947 tcp-check expect string +OK
6948
6949
6950 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
6951 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
6952
6953
6954tcp-check send <data>
6955 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
6956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 no | no | yes | yes
6958
6959 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
6960 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
6961
6962 Examples :
6963 # look for the redis master server
6964 option tcp-check
6965 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6966 tcp-check expect string role:master
6967
6968 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
6969 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
6970
6971
6972tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
6973 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
6974 tcp health check
6975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 no | no | yes | yes
6977
6978 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
6979 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
6980 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
6981 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
6982 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
6983 hexadecimal string.
6984 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
6985
6986 Examples :
6987 # redis check in binary
6988 option tcp-check
6989 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
6990 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
6991
6992
6993 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
6994 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
6995
6996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006997tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6998 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007001 Arguments :
7002 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007003 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7004 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007006 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007007
7008 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7009 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007010 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7011 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7012 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7013 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7014 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7015 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007017 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7018 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7019 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7020 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007022 Three types of actions are supported :
7023 - accept :
7024 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7025 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7026 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007028 - reject :
7029 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7030 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7031 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7032 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7033 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7034 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7035 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7036 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7037 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7038 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7039 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7040 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007041
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007042 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7043 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7044 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7045 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7046 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7047 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7048 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7049 hosts.
7050
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007051 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007052 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7053 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7054 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007055 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7056 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007057 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007058 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7059 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7060 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7061 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7062 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007064 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007065 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007066 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007067 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7068 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7069 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7070 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007072 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7073 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7074 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7075 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007077 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7078 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7079 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7080 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7081 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007082 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7083 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7084 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7085 layer7 information is extracted.
7086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007087 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7088 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7089 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7090 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7091 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007093 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7094 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7095 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007097 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7098 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7099 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007101 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007102 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007103 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007105 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7106 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7107 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007109 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007110 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7111 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007112
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007113 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7114
7115 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7116
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007117 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007119 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007120
7121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007122tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7123 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007125 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007126 Arguments :
7127 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007128 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7129 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007130 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007132 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007134 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7135 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7136 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7137 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7138 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007140 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7141 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7142 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7143 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007144 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7145 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7146 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7147 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7148 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7149 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007150 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007151 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007153 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7154 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7155 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7156 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007158 Three types of actions are supported :
7159 - accept :
7160 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007161 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007163 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7164 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007165
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007166 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7167 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7168 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7169 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7170 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7171 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007173 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007174 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7175 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007177 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007178 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7179 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7180 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7181 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007182 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7183 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7184 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007185
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007186 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7187 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7188 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7189 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7190
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007191 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007192 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7193 # and reject everything else.
7194 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7195 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007196 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007197 tcp-request content reject
7198
7199 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007200 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7201 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7202 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007203 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007204
7205 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7206 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7207 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007208 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007209 tcp-request content reject
7210
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007211 Example:
7212 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7213 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007214 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007215
7216 Example:
7217 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7218 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007219 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007221 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7222 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7223
7224 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007225 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007226 # protecting all our sites
7227 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007228 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7229 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007230 ...
7231 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7232
7233 backend http_dynamic
7234 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007235 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007236 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007237 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7238 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7239 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007240 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007242 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007244 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007245
7246
7247tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7248 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007250 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007251 Arguments :
7252 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7253 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7254 as explained at the top of this document.
7255
7256 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7257 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7258 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7259 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7260 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7261
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007262 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7263 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7264 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7265 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7266
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007267 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7268 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007269 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007270 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007271 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7272 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7273 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7274 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007275
7276 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7277 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7278 it pass through unaffected.
7279
7280 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7281 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7282 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007283 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007284 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7285 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007286 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7287 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7288 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007289
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007290 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007291 "timeout client".
7292
7293
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007294tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7295 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 no | no | yes | yes
7298 Arguments :
7299 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007300 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007301
7302 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7303
7304 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7305 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7306 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007307 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7308 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007309
7310 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7311
7312 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7313 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7314 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7315 inserted.
7316
7317 Two types of actions are supported :
7318 - accept :
7319 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7320 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7321 the rules evaluation.
7322
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007323 - close :
7324 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7325 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7326 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7327 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7328 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7329 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007330 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007331 protocols.
7332
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007333 - reject :
7334 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7335 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007336 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007337
7338 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7339 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7340 for changing the default action to a reject.
7341
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007342 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7343 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7344 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7345 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007346 period.
7347
7348 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7349
7350 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7351
7352
7353tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7354 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7356 no | no | yes | yes
7357 Arguments :
7358 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7359 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7360 as explained at the top of this document.
7361
7362 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7363
7364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007365timeout check <timeout>
7366 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7367 established.
7368
7369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | no | yes | yes
7371 Arguments:
7372 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7373 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7374 as explained at the top of this document.
7375
7376 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7377 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7378 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7379 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007380 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7381 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7382 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007383
7384 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7385 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7386
7387 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7388 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007389 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007390
7391 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7392 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7393 forget about it.
7394
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007395 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7396 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007397
7398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007399timeout client <timeout>
7400timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7401 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7403 yes | yes | yes | no
7404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7407 as explained at the top of this document.
7408
7409 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7410 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7411 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7412 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7413 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7414 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7415 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7416 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007417 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007418 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007419 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7420 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7421 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007422
7423 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7424 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7425 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7426 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7427 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7428 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7429
7430 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7431 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7432 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7433
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007434 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007435
7436
7437timeout connect <timeout>
7438timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7439 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007443 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007444 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7445 as explained at the top of this document.
7446
7447 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007448 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007449 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007450 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007451 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7452 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007453
7454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7456 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7457 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7458 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7459 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7460
7461 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7462 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7463 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7464
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007465 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7466 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007467
7468
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007469timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7470 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 yes | yes | yes | yes
7473 Arguments :
7474 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7475 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7476 as explained at the top of this document.
7477
7478 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7479 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7480 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7481 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7482 once the request has started to present itself.
7483
7484 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7485 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7486 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7487 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7488 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7489
7490 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7491 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7492 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7493 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7494
7495 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7496 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7497 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7498 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7499 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007500 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007501
7502 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7503 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7504 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7505 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7506
7507 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7508
7509
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007510timeout http-request <timeout>
7511 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007513 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007515 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007516 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7517 as explained at the top of this document.
7518
7519 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7520 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7521 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7522 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7523 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7524 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7525 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7526 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7527
7528 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7529 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007530 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7531 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007532
7533 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7534 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7535 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7536 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7537 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7538
7539 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007540 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7541 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7542 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007543
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007544 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007545
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007546
7547timeout queue <timeout>
7548 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 yes | no | yes | yes
7551 Arguments :
7552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7554 as explained at the top of this document.
7555
7556 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7557 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7558 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7559 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7560 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7561
7562 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7563 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7564 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7565 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7566
7567 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7568
7569
7570timeout server <timeout>
7571timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7572 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7574 yes | no | yes | yes
7575 Arguments :
7576 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7577 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7578 as explained at the top of this document.
7579
7580 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7581 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7582 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7583 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7584 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7585 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7586 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7587
7588 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7589 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7590 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7591 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7592 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007593 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007594 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007595 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7596 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7597 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7598 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007599
7600 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7601 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7602 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7603 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7604 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7605 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7606
7607 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7608 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7609 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7610
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007611 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007612
7613
7614timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007615 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 yes | yes | yes | yes
7618 Arguments :
7619 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7620 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7621 as explained at the top of this document.
7622
7623 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7624 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7625 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7626
7627 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7628 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7629 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7630 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007631 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007632
7633 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7634
7635
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007636timeout tunnel <timeout>
7637 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 yes | no | yes | yes
7640 Arguments :
7641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7643 as explained at the top of this document.
7644
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007645 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007646 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7647 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7648 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7649 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7650 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7651 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7652 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7653 specified.
7654
7655 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7656 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7657 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7658 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7659 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7660
7661 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7663 forget about it.
7664
7665 Example :
7666 defaults http
7667 option http-server-close
7668 timeout connect 5s
7669 timeout client 30s
7670 timeout client 30s
7671 timeout server 30s
7672 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7673
7674 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7675
7676
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007677transparent (deprecated)
7678 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007681 Arguments : none
7682
7683 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7684 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7685 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7686 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7687 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7688 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7689 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7690 appropriate server.
7691
7692 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7693
7694 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7695 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007697 See also: "option transparent"
7698
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007699unique-id-format <string>
7700 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7702 yes | yes | yes | no
7703 Arguments :
7704 <string> is a log-format string.
7705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007706 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7707 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7708 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7709 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007710
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007711 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7712 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7713 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7714 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7715 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7716 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7717 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7718 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007720 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7721 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007722
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007723 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007724
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007725 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007726
7727 will generate:
7728
7729 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7730
7731 See also: "unique-id-header"
7732
7733unique-id-header <name>
7734 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | yes | yes | no
7737 Arguments :
7738 <name> is the name of the header.
7739
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007740 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7741 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007742
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007743 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007744
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007745 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007746 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7747
7748 will generate:
7749
7750 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7751
7752 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007753
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007754use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007755 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7757 no | yes | yes | no
7758 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007759 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7760 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007761
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007762 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7763 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007764
7765 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7766 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7767 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007768 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7769 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7770 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7771 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007772
7773 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7774 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7775 assign the backend.
7776
7777 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7778 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7779 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7780 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7781 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7782 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7783
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007784 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007785 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007786 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7787 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7788 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7789
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007790 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7791 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7792 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7793 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7794 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7795 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7796 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7797 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7798 cannot be forced from the request.
7799
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007800 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007801 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7802 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7803
7804 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7805 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007806
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007807
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007808use-server <server> if <condition>
7809use-server <server> unless <condition>
7810 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 no | no | yes | yes
7813 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007814 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007815
7816 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7817
7818 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7819 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7820 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7821
7822 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7823 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7824 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7825 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7826 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7827 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7828 matches will assign the server.
7829
7830 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7831 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7832 with the next rules until one matches.
7833
7834 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7835 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7836 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7837 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7838
7839 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7840 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7841 stripped.
7842
7843 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7844 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7845 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7846 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7847
7848 Example :
7849 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7850 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7851 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7852 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7853 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7854 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7855 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7856 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7857 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7858
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007859 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007861
78625. Bind and Server options
7863--------------------------
7864
7865The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7866depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7867settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7868written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7869described in this section.
7870
7871
78725.1. Bind options
7873-----------------
7874
7875The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7876as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7877no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7878parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7879while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7880provided immediately after the setting name.
7881
7882The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7883
7884accept-proxy
7885 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7886 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7887 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7888 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7889 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7890 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7891 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7892 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7893 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007894 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7895 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007896
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007897alpn <protocols>
7898 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7899 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7900 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7901 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7902 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7903 initial NPN extension.
7904
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007905backlog <backlog>
7906 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7907 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7908
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007909ecdhe <named curve>
7910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007911 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7912 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007913
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007914ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7916 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7917 client's certificate.
7918
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007919ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7921 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7922 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7923 error is ignored.
7924
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007925ciphers <ciphers>
7926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7927 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007928 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007929 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7930 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7931
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007932crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7934 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7935 to verify client's certificate.
7936
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007937crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7939 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7940 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7941 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7942 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7943 file.
7944
7945 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7946 are loaded.
7947
7948 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7949 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7950 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7951 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7952 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7953 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7954 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7955 www.sub.example.org).
7956
7957 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7958 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7959 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7960 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7961 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7962
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007963 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007964
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007965 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7966 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08007967 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007968 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7969 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7970 clients).
7971
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007972crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007973 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7974 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007975 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007976 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007977
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007978crt-list <file>
7979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007980 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7981 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007982
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007983 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007984
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007985 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7986 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7987 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7988 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7989 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7990 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7991 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7992 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007994defer-accept
7995 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7996 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7997 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7998 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7999 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8000 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8001 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8002 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8003 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8004 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8005 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8006
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008007force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008008 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008009 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8010 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8011
8012force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008013 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008014 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8015
8016force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008017 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008018 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8019
8020force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008021 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008022 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8023
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008024gid <gid>
8025 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8026 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8027 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8028 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8029 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8030
8031group <group>
8032 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8033 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8034 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8035 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8036 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8037
8038id <id>
8039 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8040 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8041 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8042 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8043
8044interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008045 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8046 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8047 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8048 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8049 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8050 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8051 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008052
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008053level <level>
8054 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8055 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8056 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8057 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8058 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8059 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8060 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8061 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8062 counters).
8063 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8064 all counters).
8065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008066maxconn <maxconn>
8067 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8068 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8069 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8070 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8071 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8072 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8073 eat all memory.
8074
8075mode <mode>
8076 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8077 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8078 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8079 UNIX sockets.
8080
8081mss <maxseg>
8082 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8083 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8084 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8085 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8086 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8087 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8088 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8089 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8090 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8091 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8092 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8093
8094name <name>
8095 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8096 page.
8097
8098nice <nice>
8099 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8100 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8101 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8102 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8103 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8104 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8105 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8106 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8107 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8108 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8109 one for an RDP socket.
8110
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008111no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008113 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008114 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008115 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8116 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008117
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008118no-tls-tickets
8119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8120 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8121 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8122 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8123
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008124no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008126 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008127 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8128 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8129 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008130
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008131no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008133 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008134 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8135 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8136 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008137
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008138no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008140 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008141 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8142 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8143 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008144
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008145npn <protocols>
8146 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8147 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8148 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8149 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008150 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8151 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008153ssl
8154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008155 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008156 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8157 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8158 to deciphered contents.
8159
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008160strict-sni
8161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8162 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8163 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8164 See the "crt" option for more information.
8165
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008166tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008167 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008168 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8169 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8170 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8171 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8172 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8173 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8174 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008175 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8176 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8177 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008178
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008179transparent
8180 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8181 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8182 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8183 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8184 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8185 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8186 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8187 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8188 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8189 so check for support with your vendor.
8190
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008191v4v6
8192 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8193 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8194 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8195 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008196 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008197
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008198v6only
8199 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8200 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8201 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008202 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8203 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008205uid <uid>
8206 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8207 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8208 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8209 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8210 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8211
8212user <user>
8213 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8214 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8215 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8216 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8217 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8218
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008219verify [none|optional|required]
8220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8221 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8222 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8223 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8224 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008225 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8226 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8227 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8228 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020082305.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008231------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008233The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8234which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8235arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8236settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8237after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8238Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8239address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008241 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008242 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008244The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008245
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008246addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008247 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8248 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8249 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8250 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8251 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008253 Supported in default-server: No
8254
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008255agent-check
8256 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8257 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8258 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8259 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8260
8261 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8262 e.g. "75%"
8263
8264 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8265 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8266
8267 * The string "drain".
8268
8269 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8270 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8271 persistence.
8272
8273 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8274
8275 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8276
8277 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8278
8279 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8280
8281 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8282
8283 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8284
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008285 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8286 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8287 parameter.
8288
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008289 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8290 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8291
8292 Supported in default-server: No
8293
8294agent-inter <delay>
8295 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8296 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8297
8298 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8299 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8300 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8301 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8302 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8303 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8304 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8305 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8306 of backends use the same servers.
8307
8308 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8309
8310 Supported in default-server: Yes
8311
8312agent-port <port>
8313 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8314
8315 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8316
8317 Supported in default-server: Yes
8318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319backup
8320 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8321 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8322 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8323 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8324 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8325 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008327 Supported in default-server: No
8328
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008329ca-file <cafile>
8330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8331 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8332 server's certificate.
8333
8334 Supported in default-server: No
8335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008336check
8337 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008338 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8339 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8340 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8341 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8342 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8343 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8344 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008345 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8346 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8347 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008349 Supported in default-server: No
8350
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008351check-send-proxy
8352 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8353 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8354 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8355 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8356 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8357 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8358 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8359
8360 Supported in default-server: No
8361
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008362check-ssl
8363 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8364 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8365 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8366 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008367 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008368 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8369 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8370 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8371 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8372
8373 Supported in default-server: No
8374
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008375ciphers <ciphers>
8376 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008377 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008378 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8379 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8380 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8381 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8382 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8383 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8384
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008385 Supported in default-server: No
8386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008387cookie <value>
8388 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8389 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8390 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8391 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8392 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8393 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8394 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008396 Supported in default-server: No
8397
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008398crl-file <crlfile>
8399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8400 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8401 to verify server's certificate.
8402
8403 Supported in default-server: No
8404
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008405crt <cert>
8406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8407 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8408 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8409 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8410 certificate request.
8411
8412 Supported in default-server: No
8413
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008414disabled
8415 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8416 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8417 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8418 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8419 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8420
8421 Supported in default-server: No
8422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008423error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008424 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8425 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8426 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008428 Supported in default-server: Yes
8429
8430 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008432fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008433 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8434 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8435 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008437 Supported in default-server: Yes
8438
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008439force-sslv3
8440 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8441 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8442 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8443
8444 Supported in default-server: No
8445
8446force-tlsv10
8447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8448 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8449
8450 Supported in default-server: No
8451
8452force-tlsv11
8453 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8454 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8455
8456 Supported in default-server: No
8457
8458force-tlsv12
8459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8460 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8461
8462 Supported in default-server: No
8463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008464id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008465 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8466 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8467 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008469 Supported in default-server: No
8470
8471inter <delay>
8472fastinter <delay>
8473downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008474 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8475 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8476 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8477 between checks depending on the server state :
8478
8479 Server state | Interval used
8480 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8481 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8482 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8483 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8484 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8485 or yet unchecked. |
8486 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8487 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8488 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008490 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8491 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8492 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8493 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008494 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8495 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8496 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8497 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8498 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008500 Supported in default-server: Yes
8501
8502maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008503 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8504 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8505 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8506 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8507 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8508 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8509 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8510 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008512 Supported in default-server: Yes
8513
8514maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008515 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8516 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8517 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8518 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8519 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8520 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8521 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008523 Supported in default-server: Yes
8524
8525minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008526 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8527 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8528 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8529 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8530 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8531 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008532 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008533 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008535 Supported in default-server: Yes
8536
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008537no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008538 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8539 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008540 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008541
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008542 Supported in default-server: No
8543
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008544no-tls-tickets
8545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8546 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8547 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8548 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8549
8550 Supported in default-server: No
8551
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008552no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008553 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008554 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8555 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008556 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8557 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008558
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008559 Supported in default-server: No
8560
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008561no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008562 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008563 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8564 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008565 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8566 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008567
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008568 Supported in default-server: No
8569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008570no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008571 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8575 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008576
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008577 Supported in default-server: No
8578
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008579non-stick
8580 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8581 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8582 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8583
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008584 Supported in default-server: No
8585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008586observe <mode>
8587 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8588 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8589 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8590 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8591 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8592 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008593 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008595 Supported in default-server: No
8596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008597 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008599on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008600 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8601 Currently, four modes are available:
8602 - fastinter: force fastinter
8603 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8604 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8605 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8606 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008608 Supported in default-server: Yes
8609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008610 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8611
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008612on-marked-down <action>
8613 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8614 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008615 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8616 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8617 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8618 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8619 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8620 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8621 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8622 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008623
8624 Actions are disabled by default
8625
8626 Supported in default-server: Yes
8627
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008628on-marked-up <action>
8629 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8630 Currently one action is available:
8631 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8632 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8633 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8634 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8635 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8636 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8637 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8638 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8639
8640 Actions are disabled by default
8641
8642 Supported in default-server: Yes
8643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008644port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008645 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8646 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8647 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8648 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8649 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8650 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008652 Supported in default-server: Yes
8653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008654redir <prefix>
8655 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8656 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8657 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8658 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8659 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8660 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8661 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8662 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008663 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008664 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8665 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8666 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8667 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8668 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8669
8670 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008672 Supported in default-server: No
8673
8674rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008675 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8676 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8677 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008679 Supported in default-server: Yes
8680
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008681send-proxy
8682 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8683 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8684 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8685 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8686 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8687 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8688 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8689 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8690 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008691 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8692 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8693 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8694 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8695 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008696
8697 Supported in default-server: No
8698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008699slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008700 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8701 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8702 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8703 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8704 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8705 parameters :
8706
8707 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8708 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8709
8710 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8711 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8712 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8713 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8714
8715 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8716 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8717 seen as failed.
8718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008719 Supported in default-server: Yes
8720
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008721source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008722source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008723source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008724 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8725 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8726 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8727 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8728
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008729 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8730 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8731 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8732 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8733 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8734 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8735 server.
8736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008737 Supported in default-server: No
8738
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008739ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008740 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8741 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8742 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8743 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8744 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8745 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008746 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008747
8748 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008750track [<proxy>/]<server>
8751 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8752 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8753 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8754 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8755 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008757 Supported in default-server: No
8758
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008759verify [none|required]
8760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008761 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8762 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8763 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8764 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008765 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8766 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8767 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008768
8769 Supported in default-server: No
8770
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008771verifyhost <hostname>
8772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8773 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8774 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8775 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8776 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8777 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8778
8779 Supported in default-server: No
8780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008781weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008782 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8783 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8784 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008785 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8786 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8787 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8788 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8789 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8790 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008792 Supported in default-server: Yes
8793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008794
87956. HTTP header manipulation
8796---------------------------
8797
8798In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8799response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8800request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8801which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008802against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008803
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008804If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8805to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8806but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8807HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8808stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8809because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8810a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8811still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008813This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8814in section 4.2 :
8815
8816 - reqadd <string>
8817 - reqallow <search>
8818 - reqiallow <search>
8819 - reqdel <search>
8820 - reqidel <search>
8821 - reqdeny <search>
8822 - reqideny <search>
8823 - reqpass <search>
8824 - reqipass <search>
8825 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8826 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8827 - reqtarpit <search>
8828 - reqitarpit <search>
8829 - rspadd <string>
8830 - rspdel <search>
8831 - rspidel <search>
8832 - rspdeny <search>
8833 - rspideny <search>
8834 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8835 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8836
8837With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8838is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8839parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8840prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8841Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8842
8843 \t for a tab
8844 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8845 \n for a new line (LF)
8846 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8847 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8848 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8849 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8850 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8851
8852The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8853portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8854above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8855regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
88569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8857is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8858
8859The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8860after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8861
8862Notes related to these keywords :
8863---------------------------------
8864 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8865 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8866 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8867
8868 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8869 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8870 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8871
8872 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8873 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8874 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8875 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8876 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8877
8878 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8879 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8880 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8881 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8882 useless headers before adding new ones.
8883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008884 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008885 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8886
8887 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8888 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8889 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8890
8891 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8892 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008893 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008894
8895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8897----------------------------------
8898
8899Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8900client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8901The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8902these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8903but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8904data called patterns.
8905
8906
89077.1. ACL basics
8908---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008909
8910The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8911content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8912from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8913simple :
8914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008915 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008916 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008917 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8918 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008920The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8921adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008922
8923In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008925 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008926
8927This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8928Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8929and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008930an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8931conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8932as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8933are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008934
8935ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8936'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8937which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8938
8939There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8940performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008942The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8943specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8944this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008945methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8946ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008947
8948Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8949 - boolean
8950 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8951 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8952 - string
8953 - data block
8954
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008955Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8956converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8957would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8958The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8959which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008961The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8962 - boolean
8963 - integer or integer range
8964 - IP address / network
8965 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8966 - regular expression
8967 - hex block
8968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008969The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8970
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008971 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8972 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008973 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008974 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008975 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008976 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008977 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008979The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8980read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8981if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8982lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8983will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8984beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8985a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8986lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8987exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8988
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008989The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
8990parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
8991ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
8992a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
8993check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
8994
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008995The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
8996socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
8997file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
8998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008999Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9000loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9001
9002 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9003
9004In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9005the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9006case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9007as well.
9008
9009The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9010sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9011do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9012methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9013is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9014obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9015followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9016default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9017that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9018string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9019
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009020The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9021By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9022string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9023resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9024server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9025waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9026flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9027function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009029There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9030sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9031be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009032
9033 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9034 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009035 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9036 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9037 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9038 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009039
9040 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9041 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009042 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009043
9044 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009045 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009046
9047 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009048 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009049
9050 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9051 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9052
9053 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9054 binary or string samples.
9055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009056 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9057 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009059 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9060 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9061 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009063 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9064 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009066 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9067 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009069 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9070 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009072 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9073 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009074 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009076 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9077 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9078 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009079
9080For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9081request, it is possible to do :
9082
9083 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9084
9085In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9086buffer, one would use the following acl :
9087
9088 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9089
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009090On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9091possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9092
9093 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009095All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9096criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9097method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9098to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9099criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9100the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009102If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009103the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9104For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009106 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9107 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9108 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9109 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009110
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009111
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009112The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009113and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9114combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9115the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009117 +-------------------------------------------------+
9118 | Input sample type |
9119 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9120 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9121 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9122 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9123 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009124 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009125 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009126 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009127 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009128 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009129 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009130 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009131 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009132 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009133 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009134 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009135 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009136 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009137 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009138 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009139 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009140 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009141 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009142 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009143 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009144 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009145 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9146 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9147 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009148
9149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091507.1.1. Matching booleans
9151------------------------
9152
9153In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9154Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9155When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9156that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9157
9158Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9159return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9160"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091637.1.2. Matching integers
9164------------------------
9165
9166Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9167enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9168to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9169
9170Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9171matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9172lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009173
9174For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9175unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9176representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9177
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009178As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9179two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9180instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9181ranges and operators.
9182
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009183For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009184operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9185Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9186of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009188Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009189
9190 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9191 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9192 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9193 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9194 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009196For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009197
9198 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9199
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009200This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9201
9202 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092057.1.3. Matching strings
9206-----------------------
9207
9208String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9209different forms :
9210
9211 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9212 patterns ;
9213
9214 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9215 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9216
9217 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9218 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9219
9220 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9221 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9222
9223 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9224 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9225 matches.
9226
9227 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9228 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9229 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009230
9231String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9232exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9233characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9234string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9235to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009236before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009237
9238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092397.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9240---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009241
9242Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9243they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9244possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9245passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9246the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009247the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9248match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009249
9250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092517.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9252-------------------------------------
9253
9254It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9255not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9256a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9257to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9258digits may be used upper or lower case.
9259
9260Example :
9261 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9262 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9263
9264
92657.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9266---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009267
9268IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9269netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9270within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009271host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009272difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9273at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9274does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9275parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009276
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009277IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9278Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9279trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9280IPv6 patterns.
9281
9282HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9283following situations :
9284 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9285 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9286 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9287 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9288 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9289 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9290 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9291 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9292 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9293 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009295
92967.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9297----------------------------------
9298
9299Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9300combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9301
9302 - AND (implicit)
9303 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9304 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009308 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9311indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009313For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9314"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9315requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9316is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9317
9318 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9319 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9320 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9321 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9322
9323To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9324and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9325
9326 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9327 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9328 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9329 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9330
9331 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9332 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9333 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9334 use_backend www if host_www
9335
9336It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9337expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9338be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9339the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9340
9341 The following rule :
9342
9343 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9344 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9345
9346 Can also be written that way :
9347
9348 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9349
9350It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9351to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9352simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9353sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9354good use is the following :
9355
9356 With named ACLs :
9357
9358 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9359 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9360 monitor fail if site_dead
9361
9362 With anonymous ACLs :
9363
9364 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9365
9366See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9367
9368
93697.3. Fetching samples
9370---------------------
9371
9372Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9373against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9374sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9375ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9376of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9377available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9378
9379This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9380Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9381compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9382deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9383
9384The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9385matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9386method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9387indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9388
9389As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9390when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9391mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9392the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9393ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9394
9395Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9396multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9397when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9398incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9399are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9400is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9401all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9402
9403Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9404 - name
9405 - name(arg1)
9406 - name(arg1,arg2)
9407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009408
94097.3.1. Converters
9410-----------------
9411
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009412Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9413of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9414is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9415was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9416has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9417unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9418
9419These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9420sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9421the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9422support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009424The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009425
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009426lower
9427 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9428 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9429 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009430
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009431upper
9432 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9433 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9434 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009435
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009436hex
9437 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9438 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9439 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9440 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009441
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009442ipmask(<mask>)
9443 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9444 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9445 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9446 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009447
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009448http_date([<offset>])
9449 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9450 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9451 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9452 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9453 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9454 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009456language(<value>[,<default>])
9457 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9458 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9459 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9460 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9461 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9462 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9463 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9464 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9465 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9466 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9467 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9468 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009470 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009471
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009472 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9473 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009474
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009475 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9476 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9477 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9478 use_backend spanish if es
9479 use_backend french if fr
9480 use_backend english if en
9481 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009482
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009483map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9484map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9485map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9486 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9487 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9488 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9489 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9490 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9491 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9492 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9493 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009495 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9496 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9497 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009499 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9500 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009501
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009502 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9504 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9506 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9508 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9509 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9510 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9511 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9512 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9513 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9514 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9516 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9518 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009521 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9522 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9523 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9524 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9525 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009527 Example :
9528
9529 # this is a comment and is ignored
9530 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9531 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9532 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9533 | | | `---------- value
9534 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9535 | `---------------------------- key
9536 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9537
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020095397.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009540--------------------------------------------
9541
9542A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9543not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9544"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9545The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9546
9547always_false : boolean
9548 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9549 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9550
9551always_true : boolean
9552 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9553 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9554
9555avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009556 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9558 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9559 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9560 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9561 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9562 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9563 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9564 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9565 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9566 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9567 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9568 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9569 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009572 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9573 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9574 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9575 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9576 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9579 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9580 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9581 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9582 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9583 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9584 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009585
9586 Example :
9587 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9588 backend dynamic
9589 mode http
9590 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9591 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009593connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009595 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9597 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009598
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009599 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009600 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009601 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9602
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009603 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9604 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009605
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009606 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009607 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009609 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9610 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009611 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009612 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009613
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009614 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9615 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009617 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009618
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009619date([<offset>]) : integer
9620 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9621 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9622 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9623 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009624 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9625
9626 Example :
9627
9628 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9629 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009630
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009631env(<name>) : string
9632 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9633 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9634 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9635 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9636 certain way.
9637
9638 Examples :
9639 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9640 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9641
9642 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9643 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9646 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009647 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9648 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9650 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9651 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9652 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9653 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9657 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9658 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9659 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9660 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9661 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9662 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9663 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009664
9665 Example :
9666 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9667 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9668 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9669 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9670 frontend mail
9671 bind :25
9672 mode tcp
9673 maxconn 100
9674 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9675 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9676 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9677 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9681 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9682 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009683 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9684 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9685 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009688 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9689 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9690 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9692 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9693 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9694 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9695 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9696
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009697rand([<range>]) : integer
9698 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9699 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9700 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9701 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9702 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9705 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9706 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9707 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9708 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9709 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9710 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9711 methods.
9712
9713srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9714 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9715 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9716 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9717 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9718 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9719 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9720 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9721
9722srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9723 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9724 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009725 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9727 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9728 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9729 overloading servers).
9730
9731 Example :
9732 # Redirect to a separate back
9733 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9734 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9735 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9736
9737table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9738 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9739 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9740
9741table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9742 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9743 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9744 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9745
9746
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097477.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748----------------------------------
9749
9750The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9751closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9752methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9753sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9754TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009755the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9756counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9757"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009758argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9759the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9760this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761
9762be_id : integer
9763 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9764 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9765
9766dst : ip
9767 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9768 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9769 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9770 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9771 RFC 4291.
9772
9773dst_conn : integer
9774 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9775 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9776 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9777 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9778 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9779 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9780 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9781 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783dst_port : integer
9784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9785 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9786 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9787 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9788 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9789 an HTTP header.
9790
9791fe_id : integer
9792 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9793 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9794 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009796sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009797sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9798sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9799sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9801 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9802 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009804sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009805sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9806sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9807sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9809 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9810 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009812sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009813sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9814sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9815sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009816 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9817 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009818 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9819 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9820 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009821
9822 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9823 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009824 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9825 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9826 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009827 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9828 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9829
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009830sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009831sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9832sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9833sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009834 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9835 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9836
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009837sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009838sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9839sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9840sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9842 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9843 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009845sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009846sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9847sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9848sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009849 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9850 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9851 See also src_conn_rate.
9852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009853sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009854sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9855sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9856sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009857 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009858 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009860sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009861sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9862sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9863sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009864 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9865 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9866 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009867 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9868 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9869 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009871sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009872sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9873sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9874sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9876 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9877 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009879sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009880sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9881sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9882sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9884 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9885 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9886 src_http_err_rate.
9887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009888sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009889sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9890sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9891sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9893 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9894 src_http_req_cnt.
9895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009896sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009897sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9898sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9899sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9901 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9902 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9903 src_http_req_rate.
9904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009905sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009906sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9907sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9908sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009909 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009910 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9911 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9912 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9913 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009914
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009915 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9916 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009917 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009919sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009920sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9921sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9922sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9924 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9925 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9926 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9927
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009928sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009929sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9930sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9931sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009932 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9933 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9934 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9935 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9936
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009937sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009938sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9939sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9940sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9942 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9943 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9944 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009945 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009946 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009948sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009949sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9950sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9951sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009952 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9953 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9954 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9955 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9956 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009957 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009959sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009960sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9961sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9962sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009963 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9964 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9965 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009967sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009968sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9969sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9970sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009971 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9972 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009973 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009974 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9975 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9977 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9978 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009980so_id : integer
9981 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9982 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9983 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985src : ip
9986 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9987 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9988 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9989 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9990 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9991 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9992 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009993
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009994 Example:
9995 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9996 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9999 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10000 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10001 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010002 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10005 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10006 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010007 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010008 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10011 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10012 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10013 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10014 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10015 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10016 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010017
10018 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10019 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10020 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10021 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010022 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010023 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10024 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010026src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010027 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010029 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010030 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010033 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10035 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010036 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10039 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10040 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10041 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010042 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010045 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010046 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010047 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010048 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010050src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010051 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010052 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010053 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10054 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010055 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10056 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10057 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10060 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10061 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010062 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010063 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010064 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10067 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10068 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10069 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10070 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010071 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10074 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10075 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10076 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010077 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10080 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10081 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10082 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010083 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010084 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010086src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10087 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10088 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10089 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010090 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10092 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010093
10094 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010095 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010096 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010098src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10099 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10100 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10101 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10102 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010103 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10104 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10107 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10108 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010109 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10110 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010111 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113src_port : integer
10114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10115 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10116 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10117 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010119src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10120 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010121 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10122 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10123 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010124 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10127 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10128 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10129 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10130 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010131 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010133src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10134 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10135 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10136 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10137 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10138 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10139 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10140 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10141 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010142
10143 Example :
10144 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10145 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10146 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10147 listen ssh
10148 bind :22
10149 mode tcp
10150 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010151 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010152 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010153 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155srv_id : integer
10156 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10157 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10158 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010159
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010160
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101617.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10165closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10166when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10167usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010168future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010170ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10172 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10173 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10174 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10175 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10179 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10180 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10181 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010183ssl_c_err : integer
10184 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10185 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10186 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10187 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10188 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10191 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10192 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10193 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10194 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10195 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10196 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10197 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10198 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200 ACL derivatives :
10201 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203ssl_c_key_alg : string
10204 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10205 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10206 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208 ACL derivatives :
10209 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211ssl_c_notafter : string
10212 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10213 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10214 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216 ACL derivatives :
10217 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219ssl_c_notbefore : string
10220 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10222 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010224 ACL derivatives :
10225 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10228 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10229 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10230 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10231 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10232 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10233 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10234 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10235 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010237 ACL derivatives :
10238 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010240ssl_c_serial : binary
10241 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10242 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10243 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010245 ACL derivatives :
10246 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010248ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10249 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10250 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10251 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010253ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10254 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10255 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10256 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258 ACL derivatives :
10259 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10260
10261ssl_c_used : boolean
10262 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10263 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265ssl_c_verify : integer
10266 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10267 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10268 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10269 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010271ssl_c_version : integer
10272 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10273 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10277 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10278 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10279 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010280 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10282 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10283 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285 ACL derivatives :
10286 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010288ssl_f_key_alg : string
10289 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10290 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10291 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 ACL derivatives :
10294 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296ssl_f_notafter : string
10297 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10298 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10299 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301 ACL derivatives :
10302 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304ssl_f_notbefore : string
10305 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10306 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10307 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309 ACL derivatives :
10310 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010312ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10313 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10314 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10315 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10316 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10317 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10318 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10319 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10320 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010322 ACL derivatives :
10323 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325ssl_f_serial : binary
10326 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10327 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10328 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330 ACL derivatives :
10331 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10334 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10335 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10336 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338 ACL derivatives :
10339 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010341ssl_f_version : integer
10342 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10343 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10344
10345ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010346 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10347 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10348 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010350 Example :
10351 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10352 listen http-https
10353 bind :80
10354 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10355 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10356
10357ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10358 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10359 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10360
10361ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010362 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10364 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10365 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10366 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10367 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10368 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10369 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10370 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10371
10372 ACL derivatives :
10373 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010375ssl_fc_cipher : string
10376 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10377 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379 ACL derivatives :
10380 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010382ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010383 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10384 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010385 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10386 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10387 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10388 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010390ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10391 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010392 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10393 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10394 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10395 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010397ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010398 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10400 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10401 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10402 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10403 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10404 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10405 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010407 ACL derivatives :
10408 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010410ssl_fc_protocol : string
10411 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10412 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010414 ACL derivatives :
10415 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10416
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010417ssl_fc_unique_id : string
10418 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10419 returns a base64 encoded string containing the TLS unique ID as defined
10420 in RFC5929 section 3.
10421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010422ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10423 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10424 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10425 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10426 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010428ssl_fc_sni : string
10429 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10430 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10431 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10432 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10433 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10434
10435 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10436 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10437 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010438 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10439 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010441 ACL derivatives :
10442 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10443 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10444 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10447 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10448 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010449
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010454Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10455sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10456only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10457For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10458be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10459can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10460sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10461for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10462content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10465 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10466 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10467 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10470 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10471 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10472 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010474req.len : integer
10475req_len : integer (deprecated)
10476 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10477 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10478 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10479 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10480 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10481 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10482 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10483 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010485req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10486 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010487 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10488 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10489 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10490 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492 ACL alternatives :
10493 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10496 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10497 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10498 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10499 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010501 ACL alternatives :
10502 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010506req.proto_http : boolean
10507req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10508 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10509 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10510 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10511 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10512 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10513 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10514 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010516 Example:
10517 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10518 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10519 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010520 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10523rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10524 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10525 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10526 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10527 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10528 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10529 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10530 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10533 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10534 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10535 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10536 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10537 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539 ACL derivatives :
10540 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542 Example :
10543 listen tse-farm
10544 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10545 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10546 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10547 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10548 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10549 persist rdp-cookie
10550 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10551 # This is only useful makes sense if
10552 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10553 stick-table type string size 204800
10554 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10555 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10556 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010558 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10559 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10562rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10563 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10564 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10565 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10566 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010568 ACL derivatives :
10569 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10572req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10573 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10574 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10575 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10576 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10577 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10578 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10579 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581req.ssl_sni : string
10582req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10583 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10584 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10585 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10586 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10587 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10588 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10589 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10590 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10591 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10592 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10593 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10594 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596 ACL derivatives :
10597 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010599 Examples :
10600 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10601 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10602 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10603 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10604 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10607rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10608 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10609 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10610 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10611 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10612 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10613 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10614 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616req.ssl_ver : integer
10617req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10618 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10619 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10620 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10621 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10622 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10623 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10624 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10625 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10626 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628 ACL derivatives :
10629 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010630
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010631res.len : integer
10632 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10633 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10634 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10635 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10636 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10637 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10638 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10639 content inspection.
10640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10642 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010643 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10644 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10645 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10646 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10649 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10650 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10651 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10652 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010656wait_end : boolean
10657 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10658 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10659 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10660 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10661 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10662 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10663 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10664 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666 Examples :
10667 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10668 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10669 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10672 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10673 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10674 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10675 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10676 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10677 tcp-request content reject
10678
10679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106807.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681--------------------------------------
10682
10683It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10684This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10685data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10686its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10687HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10688content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10689to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10690more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10691response are indexed.
10692
10693base : string
10694 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10695 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10696 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10697 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10698 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10699 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10700 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10701 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10702
10703 ACL derivatives :
10704 base : exact string match
10705 base_beg : prefix match
10706 base_dir : subdir match
10707 base_dom : domain match
10708 base_end : suffix match
10709 base_len : length match
10710 base_reg : regex match
10711 base_sub : substring match
10712
10713base32 : integer
10714 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10715 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10716 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10717 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10718
10719base32+src : binary
10720 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10721 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10722 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10723 per-URL counters.
10724
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010725capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10726 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10727 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10728 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10729
10730capture.req.method : string
10731 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10732 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10733 because it's allocated.
10734
10735capture.req.uri : string
10736 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10737 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10738 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10739 allocated.
10740
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010741capture.req.ver : string
10742 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10743 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10744 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10745
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010746capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10747 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10748 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10749 The first entry is an index of 0.
10750 See also: "capture response header"
10751
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010752capture.res.ver : string
10753 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10754 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10755 persistent flag.
10756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757req.cook([<name>]) : string
10758cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10759 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10760 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10761 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10762 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10763 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10764 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10765 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10766 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10767
10768 ACL derivatives :
10769 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10770 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10771 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10772 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10773 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10774 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10775 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10776 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10779cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10780 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10781 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10784cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10785 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10786 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10787 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10788 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10791 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10792 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10793 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10794 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10795 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10796 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10797 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10798 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10799 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10800 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10803 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10804 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10805 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10806 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010807 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010809req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10810 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10811 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10812 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10813 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10814 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10815 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10816 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10817 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10820 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10821 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10822 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10823 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10826 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10827 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10828 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10829 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10830 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10831 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10832 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10833 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10834 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10835 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10836 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838 ACL derivatives :
10839 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10840 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10841 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10842 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10843 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10844 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10845 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10846 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10847
10848req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10849hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10850 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10851 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10852 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10853 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10854 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10855 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10856 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10857 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10858 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10859
10860req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10861hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10862 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10863 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10864 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10865 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10866 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10867 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10868 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10869 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10870
10871req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10872hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10873 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10874 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10875 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10876 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10877 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10878 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10879 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10880
10881http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10882 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10883 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10884 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10885 basic auth is supported.
10886
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010887http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10888 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10889 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10890 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10891 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10893 basic auth is supported.
10894
10895 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010896 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10897 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10898 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10899 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900
10901http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010902 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10903 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010904 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10905 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907method : integer + string
10908 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10909 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10910 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10911 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10912 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10913 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10914 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010916 ACL derivatives :
10917 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919 Example :
10920 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10921 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10922 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010924path : string
10925 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10926 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10927 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10928 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10929 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10930 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10931 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010933 ACL derivatives :
10934 path : exact string match
10935 path_beg : prefix match
10936 path_dir : subdir match
10937 path_dom : domain match
10938 path_end : suffix match
10939 path_len : length match
10940 path_reg : regex match
10941 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943req.ver : string
10944req_ver : string (deprecated)
10945 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10946 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10947 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949 ACL derivatives :
10950 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952res.comp : boolean
10953 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10954 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10955 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957res.comp_algo : string
10958 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10959 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10960 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962res.cook([<name>]) : string
10963scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10964 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10965 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10966 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968 ACL derivatives :
10969 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10972scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10973 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10974 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10975 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10978scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10979 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10980 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10981 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010983res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10984 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10985 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10986 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10987 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10988 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10989 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10990 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10991 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10992 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10995 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10996 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10997 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10998 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10999 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11002shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11003 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11004 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11005 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11006 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11007 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11008 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11009 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11010 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011012 ACL derivatives :
11013 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11014 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11015 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11016 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11017 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11018 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11019 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11020 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11021
11022res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11023shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11024 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11025 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11026 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11027 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11028 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11031shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11032 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11033 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11034 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11035 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11036 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11037 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011039res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11040shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11041 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11042 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11043 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11044 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11045 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11046 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048res.ver : string
11049resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11050 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11051 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011053 ACL derivatives :
11054 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11057 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11058 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11059 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11060 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11063 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067status : integer
11068 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11069 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11070 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011072url : string
11073 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11074 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11075 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11076 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11077 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11078 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11079 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081 ACL derivatives :
11082 url : exact string match
11083 url_beg : prefix match
11084 url_dir : subdir match
11085 url_dom : domain match
11086 url_end : suffix match
11087 url_len : length match
11088 url_reg : regex match
11089 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011091url_ip : ip
11092 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11093 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11094 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11095 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11096 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11097 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11098 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011100url_port : integer
11101 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11102 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11103 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11104 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11107url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11108 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11109 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11110 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11111 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11112 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11113 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11114 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11115 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11116 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118 ACL derivatives :
11119 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11120 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11121 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11122 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11123 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11124 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11125 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11126 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011127
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011129 Example :
11130 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11131 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11132 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11133 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011135urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11136 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11137 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11138 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011139
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111417.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011142---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011144Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11145every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011146order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011148ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11149---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011150FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011151HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011152HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11153HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011154HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11155HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11156HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11157HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11158LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011159METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11160METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11161METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11162METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11163METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11164METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011165RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011166REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011167TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011168WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11169---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011170
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111728. Logging
11173----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011175One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11176provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11177very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11178provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11179state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011180to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011181headers.
11182
11183In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11184about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11185send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11186
11187 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11188 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11189 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11190 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11191 at the termination.
11192
11193The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11194allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11195as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11196while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11197real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11198delay.
11199
11200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112018.1. Log levels
11202---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011203
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011204TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011205source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011206HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11207in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11208track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11209syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11210about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011211
11212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112138.2. Log formats
11214----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011215
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011216HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011217and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11218slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11219options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011220
11221 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11222 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11223 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11224 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11225 extents.
11226
11227 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11228 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11229 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11230 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11231 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11232
11233 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11234 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11235 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11236 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11237 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11238
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011239 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11240 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11241 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11242 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11243
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011244 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11245
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011246Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11247specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11248field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11249servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11250always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11251identifier.
11252
11253Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11254 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11255 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11256 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11257 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11258
11259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112608.2.1. Default log format
11261-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011262
11263This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11264as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11265format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11266
11267 Example :
11268 listen www
11269 mode http
11270 log global
11271 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11272
11273 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11274 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11275 (www/HTTP)
11276
11277 Field Format Extract from the example above
11278 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11279 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11280 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11281 4 'to' to
11282 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11283 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11284
11285Detailed fields description :
11286 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11287 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11288 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11289 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11290 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11291 and processed the connection.
11292 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11293
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011294In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11295"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11296connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11297
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011298It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11299will eventually disappear.
11300
11301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113028.2.2. TCP log format
11303---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011304
11305The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11306is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11307information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11308counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11309emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11310environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11311the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11312sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011313specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11314not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11315fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11316marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011317
11318 Example :
11319 frontend fnt
11320 mode tcp
11321 option tcplog
11322 log global
11323 default_backend bck
11324
11325 backend bck
11326 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11327
11328 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11329 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11330 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11331
11332 Field Format Extract from the example above
11333 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11334 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11335 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11336 4 frontend_name fnt
11337 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11338 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11339 7 bytes_read* 212
11340 8 termination_state --
11341 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11342 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11343
11344Detailed fields description :
11345 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011346 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11347 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11348 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11349 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11350 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011351
11352 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011353 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11354 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11355 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011356
11357 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11358 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11359 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11360 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11361
11362 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11363 and processed the connection.
11364
11365 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11366 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11367 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11368 applications.
11369
11370 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11371 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11372 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11373 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11374 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11375
11376 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11377 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11378 See "Timers" below for more details.
11379
11380 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11381 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11382 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11383 "Timers" below for more details.
11384
11385 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011386 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011387 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11388 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11389 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11390 details.
11391
11392 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11393 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11394 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11395 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11396 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11397
11398 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11399 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11400 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11401 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11402 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11403 for more details.
11404
11405 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011406 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011407 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11408 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11409 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011410 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011411
11412 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11413 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11414 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11415 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11416 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11417 caused by a denial of service attack.
11418
11419 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11420 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11421 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11422 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11423 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11424 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11425 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11426 denial of service attack.
11427
11428 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11429 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11430 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11431 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11432 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11433 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11434 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11435 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11436 be processed than on other servers.
11437
11438 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11439 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11440 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11441 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11442 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11443 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11444 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11445 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11446 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11447 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11448 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11449 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11450 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11451
11452 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11453 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11454 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11455 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11456 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11457 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11458 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11459 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11460
11461 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11462 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11463 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11464 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11465 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11466 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11467 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11468 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11469 occurs.
11470
11471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114728.2.3. HTTP log format
11473----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011474
11475The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11476is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11477the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11478are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11479emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11480generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11481"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11482which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011483frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11484is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011485
11486Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11487slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11488with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11489
11490 Example :
11491 frontend http-in
11492 mode http
11493 option httplog
11494 log global
11495 default_backend bck
11496
11497 backend static
11498 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11499
11500 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11501 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11502 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011503 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011504
11505 Field Format Extract from the example above
11506 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11507 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11508 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11509 4 frontend_name http-in
11510 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11511 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11512 7 status_code 200
11513 8 bytes_read* 2750
11514 9 captured_request_cookie -
11515 10 captured_response_cookie -
11516 11 termination_state ----
11517 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11518 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11519 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11520 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11521 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011522
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011523
11524Detailed fields description :
11525 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011526 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11527 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11528 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11529 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11530 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011531
11532 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011533 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11534 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11535 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011536
11537 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11538 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11539 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11540 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11541 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11542
11543 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11544 and processed the connection.
11545
11546 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11547 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11548 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11549
11550 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11551 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11552 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11553 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11554 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11555 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11556
11557 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11558 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11559 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11560 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11561 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11562 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11563
11564 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11565 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11566 See "Timers" below for more details.
11567
11568 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11569 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11570 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11571 below for more details.
11572
11573 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11574 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11575 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11576 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11577 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11578 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11579 for more details.
11580
11581 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011582 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011583 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11584 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11585 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11586 details.
11587
11588 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11589 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11590 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11591
11592 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11593 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11594 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11595 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11596 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11597 overflowing.
11598
11599 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11600 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11601 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11602 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11603 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11604 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11605 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11606 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11607
11608 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11609 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11610 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11611 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11612 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11613 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11614 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11615 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11616
11617 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11618 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11619 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11620 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11621 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11622 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11623 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11624
11625 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011626 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011627 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11628 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11629 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011630 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011631 system.
11632
11633 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11634 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11635 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11636 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11637 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11638 caused by a denial of service attack.
11639
11640 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11641 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11642 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11643 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11644 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11645 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11646 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11647 denial of service attack.
11648
11649 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11650 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11651 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11652 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11653 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11654 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11655 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11656 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11657 processed than on other servers.
11658
11659 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11660 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11661 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11662 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11663 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11664 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11665 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11666 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11667 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11668 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11669 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11670 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11671 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11672
11673 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11674 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11675 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11676 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11677 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11678 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11679 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11680 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11681
11682 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11683 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11684 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11685 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11686 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11687 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11688 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11689 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11690 occurs.
11691
11692 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11693 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11694 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11695 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11696 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11697 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11698 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11699 cookies" below for more details.
11700
11701 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11702 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11703 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11704 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11705 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11706 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11707 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11708 and cookies" below for more details.
11709
11710 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11711 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11712 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11713 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11714 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11715 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11716 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11717 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11718
11719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200117208.2.4. Custom log format
11721------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011722
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011723The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011724mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011725
11726HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11727Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11728separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11729prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11730
11731Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11732variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11733string formats ("Q").
11734
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011735If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011736as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011737less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11738the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11739
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011740Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011741In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011742in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011743
11744Flags are :
11745 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011746 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011747
11748 Example:
11749
11750 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11751 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11752
11753At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11754
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011755 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11756 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011757
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011758the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011759
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011760 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011761 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011762 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011763
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011764and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11765
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011766 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011767 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11768
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011769Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11770
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011771 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011772 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011773 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11774 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11775 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011776 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11777 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11778 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011779 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011780 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011781 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011782 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011783 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011784 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011785 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11786 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011787 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011788 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11789 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011790 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011791 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11792 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011793 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11794 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11795 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011796 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011797 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11798 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011799 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011800 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11801 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11802 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011803 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011804 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11805 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11806 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11807 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011808 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011809 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011810 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011811 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011812 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011813 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011814 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11815 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11816 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011817 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011818 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11819 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011820 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011821 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011822 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011823 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011824
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011825 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011826
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011827
118288.2.5. Error log format
11829-----------------------
11830
11831When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11832protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11833By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11834"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11835will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11836logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11837
11838The format looks like this :
11839
11840 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11841 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11842 Connection error during SSL handshake
11843
11844 Field Format Extract from the example above
11845 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11846 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11847 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11848 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11849 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11850
11851These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11852failures.
11853
11854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118558.3. Advanced logging options
11856-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011857
11858Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11859just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11860options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11861for more information about their usage.
11862
11863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118648.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11865------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011866
11867It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11868haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11869commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11870monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11871ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11872
11873 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11874 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11875 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11876 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11877
11878 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11879 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11880 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011881 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011882 such as other load-balancers.
11883
11884 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11885 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11886 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11887
11888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11890----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011891
11892The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11893what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11894or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11895"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11896just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11897log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11898after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11899is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11900with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11901with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11902
11903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11905------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011906
11907Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11908for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11909"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11910retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11911raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11912a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11913file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11914you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11915"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11916
11917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119188.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11919--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011920
11921Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11922multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11923them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11924"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11925logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11926error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11927and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11928too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11929useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11930alternative.
11931
11932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119338.4. Timing events
11934------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011935
11936Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11937reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11938the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11939frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11940mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11941
11942 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11943 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11944 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11945 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11946 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11947
11948 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11949 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11950 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11951 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11952 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11953
11954 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11955 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11956 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11957 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11958 connection never established.
11959
11960 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11961 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11962 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11963 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11964 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11965 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11966 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11967 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11968 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11969 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11970 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11971
11972 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11973 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11974 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11975 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011976 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011977
11978 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11979
11980 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11981 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11982 negative.
11983
11984These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11985protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11986that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011987due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011988close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11989session has been aborted on timeout.
11990
11991Most common cases :
11992
11993 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11994 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11995 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11996 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11997 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11998 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11999 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12000 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12001 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012002 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12003 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12004 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012005
12006 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12007 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12008 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12009 of ms on remote networks.
12010
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012011 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12012 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12013 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012014
12015 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12016 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12017 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12018 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12019 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12020 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12021 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12022 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12023 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12024 to the server until another one is released.
12025
12026Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12027
12028 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12029 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12030 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12031
12032 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12033 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12034 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12035
12036 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12037 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12038 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12039 flags.
12040
12041 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12042 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12043 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12044 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12045 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12046 the client connection was maintained open.
12047
12048 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012049 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12051 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12052
12053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120548.5. Session state at disconnection
12055-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012056
12057TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12058"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
120592-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12060each of which has a special meaning :
12061
12062 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12063 session to terminate :
12064
12065 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12066
12067 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12068 server explicitly refused it.
12069
12070 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12071 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12072 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12073 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012074 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12075
12076 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12077 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012078
12079 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12080 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12081 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12082 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12083 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12084
12085 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12086 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12087 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12088 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12089 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12090
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012091 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12092 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12093
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012094 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12095 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12096 backup connections when going up.
12097
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012098 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12101 send or receive data.
12102
12103 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12104 send or receive data.
12105
12106 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12107 with nothing left in the buffers.
12108
12109 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12110
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012111 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012112 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12113
12114 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12115 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12116 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12117 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12118 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12119
12120 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12121 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12122
12123 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12124 server (HTTP only).
12125
12126 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12127
12128 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12129 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12130 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12131
12132 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12133 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12134 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12135
12136 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12137
12138 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12139 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12140
12141 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12142 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12143 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12144
12145 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12146 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012147 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12148 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012149
12150 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12151 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12152 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12153 another server.
12154
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012155 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012156 server.
12157
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012158 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12159 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12160 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12161 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12162
12163 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12164 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12165 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12166 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12167
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012168 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12169 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12170 "use-server" rule).
12171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012172 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12173
12174 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12175 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12176
12177 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12178
12179 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12180 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12181 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12182
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012183 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12184 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012185 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012186 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12187 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12188
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012189 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12190
12191 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12192 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12193
12194 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12195
12196 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12197
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012198The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12199was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012200helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12201starvation, attacks, etc...
12202
12203The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12204alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12205easier finding and understanding.
12206
12207 Flags Reason
12208
12209 -- Normal termination.
12210
12211 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12212 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12213 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12214 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12215
12216 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12217 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12218 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12219 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12220 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12221 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012223 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12224 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012225 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012226
12227 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12228 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12229 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12230
12231 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12232 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12233 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12234 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12235 the server takes too long to respond.
12236
12237 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12238 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12239 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12240 long a time to respond.
12241
12242 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12243 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12244 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12245 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12246 and the client.
12247
12248 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12249 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12250 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12251 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12252 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12253 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12254
12255 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12256 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012257 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12258 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12259 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12260 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012261
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012262 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12263 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012265 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012266 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12267 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12268 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12269 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12270 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12271
12272 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12273 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12274 503 or 504 here.
12275
12276 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12277 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12278 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12279 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12280 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12281
12282 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12283 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012284 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012285 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12286 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12287
12288 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12289 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12290 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12291 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12292 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12293 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12294 between haproxy and the server.
12295
12296 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12297 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12298 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12299 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12300 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12301 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12302 solution is to fix the application.
12303
12304 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12305 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12306 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12307 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12308 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12309 external attacks.
12310
12311 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12312 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012313 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012314 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12315 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12316
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012317 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12318 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12319 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012320 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12321 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012323 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12324 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12325 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12326 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012327 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12328 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12329 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12330 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12331 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012332
12333 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12334 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12335 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12336 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12337
12338 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12339 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12340 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12341 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12342
12343 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12344 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12345 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12346 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12347
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012348The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12349persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12350important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12351re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12352
12353 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12354
12355 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12356 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12357 set on a GET request.
12358
12359 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12360 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012361 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012362 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12363
12364 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12365 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12366 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12367
12368 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12369 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12370 already got a cookie.
12371
12372 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12373 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12374 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12375 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12376 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12377
12378 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12379 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12380 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12381
12382 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12383 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12384 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12385
12386 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12387 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12388
12389 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12390 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12391 then advertised in the response.
12392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123948.6. Non-printable characters
12395-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012396
12397In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12398consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12399converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12400prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12401being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12402escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12403is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12404'}' when logging headers.
12405
12406Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12407issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12408containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12409
12410Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12411the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12412performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12413
12414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124158.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12416---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012417
12418Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12419achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012420section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12422the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12423the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012424locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012425not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12426user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12427a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12428wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12429
12430 Examples :
12431 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12432 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12433
12434 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12435 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12436
12437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124388.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12439---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012440
12441Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12442proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12443the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12444server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12445
12446Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12447response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012448section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012449
12450It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012451time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12452appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012453are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12454and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12455follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12456request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12457in the logs.
12458
12459 Example :
12460 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12461 listen proxy-out
12462 mode http
12463 option httplog
12464 option logasap
12465 log global
12466 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12467
12468 # log the name of the virtual server
12469 capture request header Host len 20
12470
12471 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12472 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12473
12474 # log the beginning of the referrer
12475 capture request header Referer len 20
12476
12477 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12478 capture response header Server len 20
12479
12480 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12481 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12482
12483 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12484 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12485
12486 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12487 capture response header Via len 20
12488
12489 # log the URL location during a redirection
12490 capture response header Location len 20
12491
12492 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12493 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12494 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12495 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12496 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12497
12498 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12499 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12500 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12501 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012502 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012503
12504 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12505 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12506 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12507 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12508 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012509 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510
12511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125128.9. Examples of logs
12513---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012514
12515These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12516them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12517reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12518
12519 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12520 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12521 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12522
12523 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12524 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12525
12526 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12527 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12528 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12529
12530 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12531 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12532
12533 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12534 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12535 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12536
12537 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012538 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012539 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12540 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12541
12542 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12543 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12544 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12545
12546 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12547 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012548 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012549 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12550 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12551 to return the 502 and not the server.
12552
12553 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012554 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012555
12556 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12557 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12558 Nothing was sent to any server.
12559
12560 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12561 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12562
12563 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12564 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12565 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12566 send a 408 return code to the client.
12567
12568 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12569 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12570
12571 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12572 5 seconds ("c----").
12573
12574 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12575 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012576 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012577
12578 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012580 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12581 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12582 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12583 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12584 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012585
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125879. Statistics and monitoring
12588----------------------------
12589
12590It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12591mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12592CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12593Unix socket.
12594
12595
125969.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012597---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012598
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012599The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12600page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012602 0. pxname: proxy name
12603 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12604 for server)
12605 2. qcur: current queued requests
12606 3. qmax: max queued requests
12607 4. scur: current sessions
12608 5. smax: max sessions
12609 6. slim: sessions limit
12610 7. stot: total sessions
12611 8. bin: bytes in
12612 9. bout: bytes out
12613 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012614 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012615 12. ereq: request errors
12616 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012617 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012618 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12619 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012620 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012621 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12622 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12623 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12624 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12625 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12626 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12627 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12628 25. qlimit: queue limit
12629 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12630 27. iid: unique proxy id
12631 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12632 29. throttle: warm up status
12633 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12634 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012635 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012636 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12637 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12638 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012639 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012640 UNK -> unknown
12641 INI -> initializing
12642 SOCKERR -> socket error
12643 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12644 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12645 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12646 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12647 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12648 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12649 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12650 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12651 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12652 disable-on-404
12653 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12654 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12655 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012656 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12657 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012658 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12659 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12660 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12661 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12662 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12663 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012664 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12665 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12666 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12667 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012668 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12669 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012670 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12671 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12672 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012673 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012674 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012675
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126779.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012678-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012679
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012680The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12681necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12682A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12683issuing commands by hand :
12684
12685 global
12686 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12687 stats timeout 2m
12688
12689It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12690the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12691never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12692situations :
12693
12694 global
12695 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12696 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12697 stats timeout 2m
12698
12699To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12700swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12701to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12702syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12703
12704 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12705 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12706
12707The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12708script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12709for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12710
12711The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12712that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12713editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12714(eg: watch a counter).
12715
12716The socket supports two operation modes :
12717 - interactive
12718 - non-interactive
12719
12720The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12721this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12722sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12723mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12724commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12725example :
12726
12727 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12728
12729The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12730entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12731for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12732sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12733"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12734after processing the last command of the same line.
12735
12736For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12737"prompt" command :
12738
12739 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12740 prompt
12741 > show info
12742 ...
12743 >
12744
12745Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12746delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12747that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12748parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012749
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012750It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12751on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12752own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012753
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012754The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12755If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12756all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12757it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12758
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012759add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012760 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12761 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12762 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12763 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012764
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012765add map <map> <key> <value>
12766 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12767 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012768 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12769 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12770 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012771
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012772clear counters
12773 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12774 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12775 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12776 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12777 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12778
12779clear counters all
12780 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12781 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12782 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12783
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012784clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012785 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12786 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12787 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012788
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012789clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012790 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12791 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12792 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012793
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012794clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12795 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12796
12797 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12798 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12799 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12800 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12801 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12802 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12803
12804 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12805
12806 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12807 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12808 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12809 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12810 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12811 the ACLs :
12812
12813 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12814 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12815 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12816 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12817 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12818 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12819
12820 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012821 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12822 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012823
12824 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012825 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012826 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012827 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12828 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12829 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12830 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012831
12832 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12833
12834 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012835 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012836 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12837 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012838 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12839 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12840 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012841
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012842del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12843 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012844 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12845 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12846 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12847 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012848
12849del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012850 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012851 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12852 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12853 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12854 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012855
12856disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012857 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12858
12859 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12860 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12861 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12862 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12863 re-enabled using enable agent.
12864
12865 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12866 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12867 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12868 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12869 otherwise unchanged.
12870
12871 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12872 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12873 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12874
12875 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12876 level "admin".
12877
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012878disable frontend <frontend>
12879 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12880 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12881 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12882 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12883 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12884 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12885 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12886 on the stats page.
12887
12888 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12889 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12890
12891 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12892 level "admin".
12893
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012894disable server <backend>/<server>
12895 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12896 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12897 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12898 during the maintenance.
12899
12900 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12901 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12902
12903 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012904 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012905
12906 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12907 level "admin".
12908
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012909enable agent <backend>/<server>
12910 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12911
12912 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12913 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12914
12915 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12916 level "admin".
12917
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012918enable frontend <frontend>
12919 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12920 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12921 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12922 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12923 which was disabled.
12924
12925 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12926 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12927
12928 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12929 level "admin".
12930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012931enable server <backend>/<server>
12932 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12933 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12934
12935 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012936 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012937
12938 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12939 level "admin".
12940
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012941get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012942get acl <acl> <value>
12943 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
12944 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
12945 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
12946 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
12947 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012948
12949 The first two words are:
12950
12951 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
12952 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
12953 "dom", "end" or "reg".
12954
12955 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
12956
12957 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
12958
12959 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
12960
12961 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
12962 interpretation of the case.
12963
12964 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
12965 useful with regular expressions.
12966
12967 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
12968 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
12969
12970 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
12971 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
12972 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
12973
12974 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
12975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012976get weight <backend>/<server>
12977 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12978 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12979 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12980 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12981 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012982 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012983
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012984help
12985 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12986 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012987
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012988prompt
12989 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12990 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12991 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12992 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12993 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12994 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12995 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12996 command.
12997
12998quit
12999 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013000
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013001set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013002 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13003 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13004 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013005
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013006set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013007 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13008 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13009 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13010 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13011 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013012 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13013 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13014
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013015set maxconn global <maxconn>
13016 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13017 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13018 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13019 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13020 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13021 setting.
13022
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013023set rate-limit connections global <value>
13024 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13025 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13026 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13027 is passed in number of connections per second.
13028
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013029set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13030 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13031 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013032 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13033 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013034
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013035set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13036 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13037 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13038 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13039 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13040
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013041set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13042 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13043 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13044 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13045 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13046 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13047
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013048set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013049 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13050 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13051 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13052 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013053 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13054 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013055
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013056set timeout cli <delay>
13057 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13058 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13059 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13060
13061set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13062 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13063 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013064 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13065 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13066 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13067 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13068 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13069 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13070 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13071 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13072 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13073 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13074 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13075 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13076 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013077
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013078show errors [<iid>]
13079 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13080 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013081 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13082 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13083 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013084
13085 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13086 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13087 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13088 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13089 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13090 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13091 are reported too.
13092
13093 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13094 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13095 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13096 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13097 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13098 code.
13099
13100 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13101 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13102 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13103 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13104 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13105 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13106 line.
13107
13108 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013109 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13110 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013111 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13112 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13113
13114 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13115 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13116 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13117 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13118 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13119 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13120 00204+ minal\r\n
13121 00211 \r\n
13122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013123 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013124 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13125 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13126 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13127 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13128 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13129 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013130
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013131show info
13132 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13133
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013134show map [<map>]
13135 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013136 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13137 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13138 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13139 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13140 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13141 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013142
13143show acl [<acl>]
13144 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013145 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13146 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13147 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13148 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13149 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013150
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013151show pools
13152 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13153 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13154 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13155 the pools.
13156
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013157show sess
13158 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013159 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13160 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13161
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013162show sess <id>
13163 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13164 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13165 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13166 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13167 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013168 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13169 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13170 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013171
13172show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13173 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13174 possible to dump only selected items :
13175 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13176 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13177 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13178 for example:
13179 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13180 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13181 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13182
13183 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013184 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13185 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013186 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13187 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13188 Nbproc: 1
13189 Process_num: 1
13190 (...)
13191
13192 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13193 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13194 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13195 (...)
13196 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13197
13198 $
13199
13200 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13201 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13202 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13203 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013204 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013205
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013206show table
13207 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13208 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13209 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13210 entries currently in use.
13211
13212 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013213 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013214 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13215 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013216
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013217show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013218 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13219 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13220 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013221 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13222
13223 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13224 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13225 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13226 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13227 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13228
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013229 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13230 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13231 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13232 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13233 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13234 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13235
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013236
13237 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013238 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13239 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013240
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013241 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013242 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013243 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013244 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13245 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13246 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13247 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013248
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013249 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013250 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013251 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13252 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013253
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013254 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13255 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013256 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013257 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13258 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013259
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013260 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13261 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013262 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013263 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13264 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13265
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013266 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13267 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13268 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13269 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13270 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13271
13272 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13273 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13274 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013275 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13276 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013277 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13278 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013279
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013280shutdown frontend <frontend>
13281 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13282 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13283 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13284 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13285 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13286 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13287 once it is terminated.
13288
13289 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13290 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13291
13292 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13293 level "admin".
13294
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013295shutdown session <id>
13296 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13297 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13298 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13299 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13300 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13301 flag in the logs.
13302
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013303shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13304 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13305 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13306 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13307 'K' flag in the logs.
13308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013309/*
13310 * Local variables:
13311 * fill-column: 79
13312 * End:
13313 */